Linux Audio

Check our new training course

Loading...
v5.14.15
   1/* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
   2#ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
   3#define __NET_CFG80211_H
   4/*
   5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface
   6 *
   7 * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
   9 * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
  10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2021 Intel Corporation
  11 */
  12
  13#include <linux/ethtool.h>
  14#include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
  15#include <linux/netdevice.h>
  16#include <linux/debugfs.h>
  17#include <linux/list.h>
  18#include <linux/bug.h>
  19#include <linux/netlink.h>
  20#include <linux/skbuff.h>
  21#include <linux/nl80211.h>
  22#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  23#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  24#include <linux/net.h>
  25#include <linux/rfkill.h>
  26#include <net/regulatory.h>
  27
  28/**
  29 * DOC: Introduction
  30 *
  31 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
  32 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
  33 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
  34 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
  35 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
  36 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
  37 *
  38 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
  39 * use restrictions.
  40 */
  41
  42
  43/**
  44 * DOC: Device registration
  45 *
  46 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
  47 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
  48 * described below.
  49 *
  50 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
  51 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
  52 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
  53 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
  54 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
  55 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the
  56 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
  57 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
  58 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
  59 *
  60 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
  61 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
  62 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
  63 */
  64
  65struct wiphy;
  66
  67/*
  68 * wireless hardware capability structures
  69 */
  70
  71/**
  72 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
  73 *
  74 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
  75 *
  76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
  77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
  78 *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
 
 
  79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
  80 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
  81 *	is not permitted.
  82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
  83 *	is not permitted.
  84 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
  85 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
  86 *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
  87 *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
  88 *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
  89 *	restrictions.
  90 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
  91 *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
  92 *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
  93 *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
  94 *	restrictions.
  95 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
  96 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
  97 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
  98 *	on this channel.
  99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
 100 *	on this channel.
 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
 102 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
 103 *	on this channel.
 104 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
 105 *	on this channel.
 106 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
 107 *	on this channel.
 108 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
 109 *	on this channel.
 110 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
 111 *	on this channel.
 112 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 113 */
 114enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
 115	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
 116	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
 117	/* hole at 1<<2 */
 118	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
 119	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
 120	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
 121	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
 122	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
 123	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
 124	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
 125	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
 126	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
 127	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
 128	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
 129	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
 130	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
 131	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
 132	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
 133	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
 
 
 
 
 
 134};
 135
 136#define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
 137	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
 138
 139#define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
 140#define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
 141
 142/**
 143 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
 144 *
 145 * This structure describes a single channel for use
 146 * with cfg80211.
 147 *
 148 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
 149 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
 150 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
 151 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
 152 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
 153 *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
 154 * @band: band this channel belongs to.
 155 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
 156 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
 157 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
 158 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
 159 *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
 160 *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
 161 * @orig_mag: internal use
 162 * @orig_mpwr: internal use
 163 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
 164 *	on this channel.
 165 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
 166 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
 
 167 */
 168struct ieee80211_channel {
 169	enum nl80211_band band;
 170	u32 center_freq;
 171	u16 freq_offset;
 172	u16 hw_value;
 173	u32 flags;
 174	int max_antenna_gain;
 175	int max_power;
 176	int max_reg_power;
 177	bool beacon_found;
 178	u32 orig_flags;
 179	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
 180	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
 181	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
 182	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
 
 183};
 184
 185/**
 186 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
 187 *
 188 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
 189 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
 190 * different bands/PHY modes.
 191 *
 192 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
 193 *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
 194 *	with CCK rates.
 195 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
 196 *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
 197 *	core code when registering the wiphy.
 198 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
 199 *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
 200 *	core code when registering the wiphy.
 201 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
 202 *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
 203 *	core code when registering the wiphy.
 204 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
 205 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
 206 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
 207 */
 208enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
 209	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
 210	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
 211	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
 212	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
 213	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
 214	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
 215	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
 216};
 217
 218/**
 219 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
 220 *
 221 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
 222 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
 223 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
 224 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
 225 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
 226 */
 227enum ieee80211_bss_type {
 228	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
 229	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
 230	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
 231	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
 232	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
 233};
 234
 235/**
 236 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
 237 *
 238 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
 239 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
 240 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
 241 */
 242enum ieee80211_privacy {
 243	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
 244	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
 245	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
 246};
 247
 248#define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
 249	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
 250
 251/**
 252 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
 253 *
 254 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
 255 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
 256 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
 257 * passed around.
 258 *
 259 * @flags: rate-specific flags
 260 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
 261 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
 262 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
 263 *	short preamble is used
 264 */
 265struct ieee80211_rate {
 266	u32 flags;
 267	u16 bitrate;
 268	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
 269};
 270
 271/**
 272 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
 273 *
 274 * @enable: is the feature enabled.
 275 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
 276 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
 277 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
 278 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
 279 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
 280 *	members of the SRG
 281 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
 282 *	used by members of the SRG
 283 */
 284struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
 285	bool enable;
 286	u8 sr_ctrl;
 287	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
 288	u8 min_offset;
 289	u8 max_offset;
 290	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
 291	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
 292};
 293
 294/**
 295 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
 296 *
 297 * @color: the current color.
 298 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
 299 * @partial: define the AID equation.
 300 */
 301struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
 302	u8 color;
 303	bool enabled;
 304	bool partial;
 305};
 306
 307/**
 308 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
 309 *
 310 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 311 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
 312 *
 313 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
 314 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
 315 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
 316 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
 317 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
 318 */
 319struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
 320	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
 321	bool ht_supported;
 322	u8 ampdu_factor;
 323	u8 ampdu_density;
 324	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
 325};
 326
 327/**
 328 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
 329 *
 330 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 331 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
 332 *
 333 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
 334 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
 335 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
 336 */
 337struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
 338	bool vht_supported;
 339	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
 340	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
 341};
 342
 343#define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
 344
 345/**
 346 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
 347 *
 348 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 349 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
 350 *
 351 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
 352 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
 353 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
 354 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
 355 */
 356struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
 357	bool has_he;
 358	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
 359	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
 360	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
 361};
 362
 363/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 364 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
 365 *
 366 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
 367 * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
 368 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
 369 *
 370 * @types_mask: interface types mask
 371 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
 372 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
 373 *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
 
 374 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
 375 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
 376 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
 377 */
 378struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
 379	u16 types_mask;
 380	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
 381	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
 
 382	struct {
 383		const u8 *data;
 384		unsigned int len;
 385	} vendor_elems;
 386};
 387
 388/**
 389 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
 390 *
 391 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
 392 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
 393 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
 394 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
 395 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
 396 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
 397 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
 398 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
 399 *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
 400 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
 401 *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
 402 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
 403 *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
 404 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
 405 *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
 406 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
 407 *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
 408 */
 409enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
 410	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
 411	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
 412	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
 413	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
 414	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
 415	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
 416	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
 417	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
 418	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
 419	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
 420	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
 421	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
 422};
 423
 424/**
 425 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
 426 *
 427 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 428 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
 429 *
 430 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
 431 *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
 432 *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
 433 *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
 434 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
 435 *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
 436 */
 437struct ieee80211_edmg {
 438	u8 channels;
 439	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
 440};
 441
 442/**
 443 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
 444 *
 445 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 446 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
 447 *
 448 * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA
 449 * @cap: S1G capabilities information
 450 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
 451 */
 452struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
 453	bool s1g;
 454	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
 455	u8 nss_mcs[5];
 456};
 457
 458/**
 459 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
 460 *
 461 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
 462 * is able to operate in.
 463 *
 464 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
 465 *	in this band.
 466 * @band: the band this structure represents
 467 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
 468 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
 469 *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
 470 *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
 471 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
 472 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
 473 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
 474 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
 475 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
 476 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
 477 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
 478 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
 479 *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
 480 *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
 481 *	iftype_data).
 482 */
 483struct ieee80211_supported_band {
 484	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
 485	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
 486	enum nl80211_band band;
 487	int n_channels;
 488	int n_bitrates;
 489	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
 490	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
 491	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
 492	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
 493	u16 n_iftype_data;
 494	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data;
 495};
 496
 497/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 498 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
 499 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
 500 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
 501 *
 502 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
 503 */
 504static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
 505ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
 506				u8 iftype)
 507{
 
 508	int i;
 509
 510	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
 511		return NULL;
 512
 513	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++)  {
 514		const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
 515			&sband->iftype_data[i];
 516
 
 517		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
 518			return data;
 519	}
 520
 521	return NULL;
 522}
 523
 524/**
 525 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
 526 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
 527 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
 528 *
 529 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
 530 */
 531static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
 532ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
 533			    u8 iftype)
 534{
 535	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
 536		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
 537
 538	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
 539		return &data->he_cap;
 540
 541	return NULL;
 542}
 543
 544/**
 545 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
 546 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
 547 * @iftype: the iftype to search for
 548 *
 549 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
 550 */
 551static inline __le16
 552ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
 553			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
 554{
 555	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
 556		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
 557
 558	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
 559		return 0;
 560
 561	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
 562}
 563
 564/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 565 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
 566 *
 567 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
 568 *
 569 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
 570 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
 571 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
 572 *
 573 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
 574 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
 575 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
 576 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
 577 * without affecting other devices.
 578 *
 579 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
 580 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
 581 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
 582 */
 583#ifdef CONFIG_OF
 584void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
 585#else /* CONFIG_OF */
 586static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
 587{
 588}
 589#endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
 590
 591
 592/*
 593 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
 594 */
 595
 596/**
 597 * DOC: Actions and configuration
 598 *
 599 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
 600 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
 601 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
 602 * operations use are described separately.
 603 *
 604 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
 605 * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
 606 *
 607 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
 608 * in a separate chapter.
 609 */
 610
 611#define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
 612				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
 613
 614/**
 615 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
 616 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
 617 *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
 618 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
 619 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
 620 *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
 621 *	determine the address as needed.
 622 *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
 623 *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
 624 **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
 625 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
 626 *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
 627 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
 628 *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
 629 */
 630struct vif_params {
 631	u32 flags;
 632	int use_4addr;
 633	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
 634	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
 635	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
 636};
 637
 638/**
 639 * struct key_params - key information
 640 *
 641 * Information about a key
 642 *
 643 * @key: key material
 644 * @key_len: length of key material
 645 * @cipher: cipher suite selector
 646 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
 647 *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
 648 *	length given by @seq_len.
 649 * @seq_len: length of @seq.
 650 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
 651 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
 652 */
 653struct key_params {
 654	const u8 *key;
 655	const u8 *seq;
 656	int key_len;
 657	int seq_len;
 658	u16 vlan_id;
 659	u32 cipher;
 660	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
 661};
 662
 663/**
 664 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
 665 * @chan: the (control) channel
 666 * @width: channel width
 667 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
 668 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
 669 *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
 670 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
 671 *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
 672 *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
 673 *	parameters are ignored.
 674 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
 675 */
 676struct cfg80211_chan_def {
 677	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
 678	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
 679	u32 center_freq1;
 680	u32 center_freq2;
 681	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
 682	u16 freq1_offset;
 683};
 684
 685/*
 686 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
 687 */
 688struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
 689	struct {
 690		u32 legacy;
 691		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
 692		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
 693		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
 694		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
 695		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
 696		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
 697	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 698};
 699
 700
 701/**
 702 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
 703 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
 704 *	of the peer.
 705 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
 706 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
 707 *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
 708 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
 709 * @retry_long: retry count value
 710 * @retry_short: retry count value
 711 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
 712 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
 713 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
 714 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
 715 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
 716 */
 717struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
 718	bool config_override;
 719	u8 tids;
 720	u64 mask;
 721	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
 722	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
 723	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
 724	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
 725	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
 726	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
 727	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
 728};
 729
 730/**
 731 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
 732 * @peer: Station's MAC address
 733 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
 734 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
 735 */
 736struct cfg80211_tid_config {
 737	const u8 *peer;
 738	u32 n_tid_conf;
 739	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[];
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 740};
 741
 742/**
 743 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
 744 * @chandef: the channel definition
 745 *
 746 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
 747 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
 748 */
 749static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
 750cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
 751{
 752	switch (chandef->width) {
 753	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
 754		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
 755	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
 756		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
 757	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
 758		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
 759			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
 760		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
 761	default:
 762		WARN_ON(1);
 763		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
 764	}
 765}
 766
 767/**
 768 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
 769 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
 770 * @channel: the control channel
 771 * @chantype: the channel type
 772 *
 773 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
 774 */
 775void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
 776			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
 777			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
 778
 779/**
 780 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
 781 * @chandef1: first channel definition
 782 * @chandef2: second channel definition
 783 *
 784 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
 785 * identical, %false otherwise.
 786 */
 787static inline bool
 788cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
 789			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
 790{
 791	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
 792		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
 793		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
 794		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
 795		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
 796}
 797
 798/**
 799 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
 800 *
 801 * @chandef: the channel definition
 802 *
 803 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
 804 */
 805static inline bool
 806cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
 807{
 808	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
 809}
 810
 811/**
 812 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
 813 * @chandef1: first channel definition
 814 * @chandef2: second channel definition
 815 *
 816 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
 817 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
 818 */
 819const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
 820cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
 821			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
 822
 823/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 824 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
 825 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
 826 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
 827 */
 828bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
 829
 830/**
 831 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
 832 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
 833 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
 834 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
 835 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
 836 */
 837bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
 838			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
 839			     u32 prohibited_flags);
 840
 841/**
 842 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
 843 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
 844 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
 845 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
 846 * Returns:
 847 *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
 848 */
 849int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
 850				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
 851				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
 852
 853/**
 854 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 855 *
 856 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
 857 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
 858 *
 859 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
 860 *
 861 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
 862 */
 863static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
 864ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
 865{
 866	switch (chandef->width) {
 867	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
 868		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
 869	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
 870		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
 871	default:
 872		break;
 873	}
 874	return 0;
 875}
 876
 877/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 878 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
 879 *
 880 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
 881 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
 882 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
 883 *
 884 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
 885 *
 886 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
 887 */
 888static inline int
 889ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
 890{
 891	switch (chandef->width) {
 892	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
 893		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
 894			   chandef->chan->max_power);
 895	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
 896		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
 897			   chandef->chan->max_power);
 898	default:
 899		break;
 900	}
 901	return chandef->chan->max_power;
 902}
 903
 904/**
 905 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
 906 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
 907 * @band_mask: which bands to check on
 908 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
 909 *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
 910 */
 911bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
 912				  unsigned long band_mask,
 913				  u32 prohibited_flags);
 914
 915/**
 916 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
 917 *
 918 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
 919 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
 920 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
 921 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
 922 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
 923 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
 924 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
 925 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
 926 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
 927 *
 928 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
 929 * it has filled in during the get_survey().
 930 */
 931enum survey_info_flags {
 932	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
 933	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
 934	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
 935	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
 936	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
 937	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
 938	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
 939	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
 940	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
 941};
 942
 943/**
 944 * struct survey_info - channel survey response
 945 *
 946 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
 947 *	record to report global statistics
 948 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
 949 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
 950 *	optional
 951 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
 952 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
 953 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
 954 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
 955 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
 956 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
 957 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
 958 *
 959 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
 960 *
 961 * This structure can later be expanded with things like
 962 * channel duty cycle etc.
 963 */
 964struct survey_info {
 965	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
 966	u64 time;
 967	u64 time_busy;
 968	u64 time_ext_busy;
 969	u64 time_rx;
 970	u64 time_tx;
 971	u64 time_scan;
 972	u64 time_bss_rx;
 973	u32 filled;
 974	s8 noise;
 975};
 976
 977#define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS	4
 978
 979/**
 980 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
 981 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
 982 *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
 983 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
 984 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
 985 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
 986 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
 987 * @akm_suites: AKM suites
 988 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
 989 *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
 990 *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
 991 *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
 992 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
 993 *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
 994 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
 995 *	protocol frames.
 996 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
 997 *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
 998 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
 999 *	port for mac80211
1000 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
1001 *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
1002 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
1003 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1004 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1005 *	offload)
1006 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1007 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1008 *
1009 *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1010 *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1011 *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1012 *	  such a scenario.
1013 *
1014 *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1015 *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1016 *
1017 *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1018 *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1019 *
1020 *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1021 *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1022 */
1023struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1024	u32 wpa_versions;
1025	u32 cipher_group;
1026	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1027	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1028	int n_akm_suites;
1029	u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES];
1030	bool control_port;
1031	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1032	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1033	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1034	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1035	struct key_params *wep_keys;
1036	int wep_tx_key;
1037	const u8 *psk;
1038	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1039	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1040	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1041};
1042
1043/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1044 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
 
1045 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1046 *	or %NULL if not changed
1047 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1048 *	or %NULL if not changed
1049 * @head_len: length of @head
1050 * @tail_len: length of @tail
1051 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1052 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1053 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1054 *	frames or %NULL
1055 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1056 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1057 *	Response frames or %NULL
1058 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1059 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1060 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
 
 
1061 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1062 *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1063 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1064 *	(measurement type 8)
1065 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1066 *	Token (measurement type 11)
1067 * @lci_len: LCI data length
1068 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
 
 
 
1069 */
1070struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
 
 
1071	const u8 *head, *tail;
1072	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1073	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1074	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1075	const u8 *probe_resp;
1076	const u8 *lci;
1077	const u8 *civicloc;
 
 
1078	s8 ftm_responder;
1079
1080	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1081	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1082	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1083	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1084	size_t probe_resp_len;
1085	size_t lci_len;
1086	size_t civicloc_len;
 
 
1087};
1088
1089struct mac_address {
1090	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1091};
1092
1093/**
1094 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1095 *
1096 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1097 *	entry specified by mac_addr
1098 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1099 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1100 */
1101struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1102	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1103	int n_acl_entries;
1104
1105	/* Keep it last */
1106	struct mac_address mac_addrs[];
1107};
1108
1109/**
1110 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1111 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1112 *
 
1113 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1114 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1115 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1116 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1117 *	frame headers.
1118 */
1119struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
 
1120	u32 min_interval;
1121	u32 max_interval;
1122	size_t tmpl_len;
1123	const u8 *tmpl;
1124};
1125
1126/**
1127 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1128 *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1129 *
 
1130 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1131 *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1132 *	scanning
1133 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1134 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1135 */
1136struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
 
1137	u32 interval;
1138	size_t tmpl_len;
1139	const u8 *tmpl;
1140};
1141
1142/**
1143 * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
1144 *
1145 * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings
1146 *
1147 * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication
1148 */
1149enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags {
1150	AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0),
1151};
1152
1153/**
1154 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1155 *
1156 * Used to configure an AP interface.
1157 *
1158 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1159 * @beacon: beacon data
1160 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1161 * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1162 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1163 *	user space)
1164 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1165 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1166 * @crypto: crypto settings
1167 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1168 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1169 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1170 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1171 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1172 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1173 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1174 *	MAC address based access control
1175 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1176 *	networks.
1177 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1178 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1179 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1180 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
 
 
1181 * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1182 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1183 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1184 * @he_required: stations must support HE
1185 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1186 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags
1187 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1188 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1189 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1190 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1191 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
 
 
 
 
1192 */
1193struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1194	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1195
1196	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1197
1198	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1199	const u8 *ssid;
1200	size_t ssid_len;
1201	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1202	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1203	bool privacy;
1204	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1205	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1206	int inactivity_timeout;
1207	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1208	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1209	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1210	bool pbss;
1211	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1212
1213	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1214	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1215	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1216	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
 
 
1217	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1218	bool twt_responder;
1219	u32 flags;
1220	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1221	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1222	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1223	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1224};
1225
1226/**
1227 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1228 *
1229 * Used for channel switch
1230 *
1231 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1232 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1233 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1234 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1235 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1236 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1237 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1238 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1239 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1240 * @count: number of beacons until switch
 
 
 
1241 */
1242struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1243	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1244	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1245	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1246	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1247	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1248	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1249	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1250	bool radar_required;
1251	bool block_tx;
1252	u8 count;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1253};
1254
1255/**
1256 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1257 *
1258 * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1259 *
1260 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1261 *	to use for verification
1262 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1263 *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1264 *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1265 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1266 *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1267 *	nl80211_iftype.
1268 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1269 *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1270 *	the verification
1271 */
1272struct iface_combination_params {
1273	int num_different_channels;
1274	u8 radar_detect;
1275	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1276	u32 new_beacon_int;
1277};
1278
1279/**
1280 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1281 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1282 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1283 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1284 *
1285 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1286 * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1287 */
1288enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1289	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1290	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1291	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1292	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3),
1293};
1294
1295/**
1296 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1297 *
1298 * Used to configure txpower for station.
1299 *
1300 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1301 *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1302 *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1303 *	power per-interface or per-station.
1304 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1305 *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1306 *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1307 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1308 *	per peer TPC.
1309 */
1310struct sta_txpwr {
1311	s16 power;
1312	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1313};
1314
1315/**
1316 * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1317 *
1318 * Used to change and create a new station.
1319 *
1320 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
 
 
1321 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1322 *	(or NULL for no change)
1323 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1324 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1325 *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1326 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1327 *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1328 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1329 * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1330 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1331 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1332 * @plink_action: plink action to take
1333 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1334 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1335 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1336 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1337 *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1338 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1339 *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1340 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1341 *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1342 *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1343 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1344 *	to unknown)
1345 * @capability: station capability
1346 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1347 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1348 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1349 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1350 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1351 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1352 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1353 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1354 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1355 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1356 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1357 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1358 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1359 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1360 */
1361struct station_parameters {
1362	const u8 *supported_rates;
1363	struct net_device *vlan;
1364	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1365	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1366	int listen_interval;
1367	u16 aid;
1368	u16 vlan_id;
1369	u16 peer_aid;
1370	u8 supported_rates_len;
1371	u8 plink_action;
1372	u8 plink_state;
1373	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1374	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1375	u8 uapsd_queues;
1376	u8 max_sp;
1377	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1378	u16 capability;
1379	const u8 *ext_capab;
1380	u8 ext_capab_len;
1381	const u8 *supported_channels;
1382	u8 supported_channels_len;
1383	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1384	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1385	u8 opmode_notif;
1386	bool opmode_notif_used;
1387	int support_p2p_ps;
1388	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1389	u8 he_capa_len;
1390	u16 airtime_weight;
1391	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1392	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1393};
1394
1395/**
1396 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1397 *
1398 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1399 *
1400 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1401 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1402 *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1403 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1404 */
1405struct station_del_parameters {
1406	const u8 *mac;
1407	u8 subtype;
1408	u16 reason_code;
1409};
1410
1411/**
1412 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1413 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1414 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1415 *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1416 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1417 *	the AP MLME in the device
1418 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1419 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1420 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1421 *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1422 *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1423 *	supported/used)
1424 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1425 *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1426 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1427 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1428 */
1429enum cfg80211_station_type {
1430	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1431	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1432	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1433	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1434	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1435	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1436	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1437	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1438	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1439};
1440
1441/**
1442 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1443 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1444 * @params: the new parameters for a station
1445 * @statype: the type of station being modified
1446 *
1447 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1448 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1449 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1450 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1451 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1452 */
1453int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1454				  struct station_parameters *params,
1455				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1456
1457/**
1458 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1459 *
1460 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1461 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1462 *
1463 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1464 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1465 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1466 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1467 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1468 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1469 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
 
 
1470 */
1471enum rate_info_flags {
1472	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1473	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1474	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1475	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1476	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1477	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1478	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
 
 
1479};
1480
1481/**
1482 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1483 *
1484 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1485 *
1486 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1487 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1488 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1489 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1490 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1491 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1492 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1493 */
1494enum rate_info_bw {
1495	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1496	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1497	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1498	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1499	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1500	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1501	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1502};
1503
1504/**
1505 * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1506 *
1507 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1508 *
1509 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1510 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate
1511 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
 
1512 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1513 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1514 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1515 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1516 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1517 *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1518 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
 
 
 
1519 */
1520struct rate_info {
1521	u8 flags;
1522	u8 mcs;
1523	u16 legacy;
 
1524	u8 nss;
1525	u8 bw;
1526	u8 he_gi;
1527	u8 he_dcm;
1528	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1529	u8 n_bonded_ch;
 
 
1530};
1531
1532/**
1533 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1534 *
1535 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1536 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1537 *
1538 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1539 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1540 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1541 */
1542enum bss_param_flags {
1543	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1544	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1545	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1546};
1547
1548/**
1549 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1550 *
1551 * Information about the currently associated BSS
1552 *
1553 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1554 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1555 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1556 */
1557struct sta_bss_parameters {
1558	u8 flags;
1559	u8 dtim_period;
1560	u16 beacon_interval;
1561};
1562
1563/**
1564 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1565 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1566 *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1567 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1568 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1569 * @flows: number of new flows seen
1570 * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1571 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1572 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1573 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1574 * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1575 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1576 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1577 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1578 */
1579struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1580	u32 filled;
1581	u32 backlog_bytes;
1582	u32 backlog_packets;
1583	u32 flows;
1584	u32 drops;
1585	u32 ecn_marks;
1586	u32 overlimit;
1587	u32 overmemory;
1588	u32 collisions;
1589	u32 tx_bytes;
1590	u32 tx_packets;
1591	u32 max_flows;
1592};
1593
1594/**
1595 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1596 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1597 *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1598 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1599 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1600 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1601 *	transmitted MSDUs
1602 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1603 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1604 */
1605struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1606	u32 filled;
1607	u64 rx_msdu;
1608	u64 tx_msdu;
1609	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1610	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1611	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1612};
1613
1614#define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
1615
1616/**
1617 * struct station_info - station information
1618 *
1619 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
1620 *
1621 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
1622 *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
1623 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
1624 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
1625 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
1626 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
1627 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
1628 * @llid: mesh local link id
1629 * @plid: mesh peer link id
1630 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
1631 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1632 *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1633 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1634 *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1635 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
1636 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
1637 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
1638 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
1639 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
1640 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
1641 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
1642 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
1643 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
1644 * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
1645 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
1646 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1647 *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
1648 *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1649 *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1650 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
1651 *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
1652 *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
1653 *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
1654 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
1655 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
1656 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
1657 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
1658 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
1659 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
1660 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
1661 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
1662 *	towards this station.
1663 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
1664 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
1665 *	from this peer
1666 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
1667 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
1668 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
1669 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
1670 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
1671 *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
1672 *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
1673 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
1674 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
1675 *	been sent.
1676 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
1677 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
1678 *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
1679 *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
1680 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
1681 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1682 */
1683struct station_info {
1684	u64 filled;
1685	u32 connected_time;
1686	u32 inactive_time;
1687	u64 assoc_at;
1688	u64 rx_bytes;
1689	u64 tx_bytes;
1690	u16 llid;
1691	u16 plid;
1692	u8 plink_state;
1693	s8 signal;
1694	s8 signal_avg;
1695
1696	u8 chains;
1697	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1698	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1699
1700	struct rate_info txrate;
1701	struct rate_info rxrate;
1702	u32 rx_packets;
1703	u32 tx_packets;
1704	u32 tx_retries;
1705	u32 tx_failed;
1706	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
1707	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
1708	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
1709
1710	int generation;
1711
1712	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
1713	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
1714
1715	u32 beacon_loss_count;
1716	s64 t_offset;
1717	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1718	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
1719	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
1720
1721	u32 expected_throughput;
1722
1723	u64 tx_duration;
1724	u64 rx_duration;
1725	u64 rx_beacon;
1726	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
1727	u8 connected_to_gate;
1728
1729	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
1730	s8 ack_signal;
1731	s8 avg_ack_signal;
1732
1733	u16 airtime_weight;
1734
1735	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
1736	u32 fcs_err_count;
1737
1738	u32 airtime_link_metric;
1739
1740	u8 connected_to_as;
 
 
 
 
 
 
1741};
1742
1743/**
1744 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
1745 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
1746 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
1747 */
1748struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
1749	s32 power;
1750	u32 freq_range_index;
1751};
1752
1753/**
1754 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
1755 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
1756 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
1757 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
1758 */
1759struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
1760	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
1761	u32 num_sub_specs;
1762	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[];
1763};
1764
1765
1766/**
1767 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
1768 * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
1769 * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
1770 */
1771struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
1772	u32 start_freq;
1773	u32 end_freq;
1774};
1775
1776/**
1777 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
1778 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
1779 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
1780 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
1781 *
1782 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
1783 * range to small ones and then append them.
1784 */
1785struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
1786	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
1787	u32 num_freq_ranges;
1788	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
1789};
1790
1791#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
1792/**
1793 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
1794 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
1795 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
1796 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
1797 *
1798 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
1799 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
1800 * considered undefined.
1801 */
1802int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
1803			 struct station_info *sinfo);
1804#else
1805static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
1806				       const u8 *mac_addr,
1807				       struct station_info *sinfo)
1808{
1809	return -ENOENT;
1810}
1811#endif
1812
1813/**
1814 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
1815 *
1816 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
1817 * according to the nl80211 flags.
1818 *
1819 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
1820 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
1821 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
1822 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
1823 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
1824 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
1825 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
1826 */
1827enum monitor_flags {
1828	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
1829	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
1830	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
1831	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
1832	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
1833	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
1834	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
1835};
1836
1837/**
1838 * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
1839 *
1840 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
1841 * in during get_station() or dump_station().
1842 *
1843 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
1844 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
1845 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
1846 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
1847 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
1848 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
1849 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
1850 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
1851 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
1852 */
1853enum mpath_info_flags {
1854	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
1855	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
1856	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
1857	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
1858	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
1859	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
1860	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
1861	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
1862	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
1863};
1864
1865/**
1866 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
1867 *
1868 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
1869 *
1870 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
1871 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
1872 * @sn: target sequence number
1873 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
1874 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
1875 * @flags: mesh path flags
1876 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
1877 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
1878 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1879 *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
1880 *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1881 *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1882 * @hop_count: hops to destination
1883 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
1884 */
1885struct mpath_info {
1886	u32 filled;
1887	u32 frame_qlen;
1888	u32 sn;
1889	u32 metric;
1890	u32 exptime;
1891	u32 discovery_timeout;
1892	u8 discovery_retries;
1893	u8 flags;
1894	u8 hop_count;
1895	u32 path_change_count;
1896
1897	int generation;
1898};
1899
1900/**
1901 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
1902 *
1903 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
1904 *
 
1905 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
1906 *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1907 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
1908 *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1909 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
1910 *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1911 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1912 *	(or NULL for no change)
1913 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
1914 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
1915 *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1916 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
1917 *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
1918 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
1919 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
1920 */
1921struct bss_parameters {
 
1922	int use_cts_prot;
1923	int use_short_preamble;
1924	int use_short_slot_time;
1925	const u8 *basic_rates;
1926	u8 basic_rates_len;
1927	int ap_isolate;
1928	int ht_opmode;
1929	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
1930};
1931
1932/**
1933 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
1934 *
1935 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
1936 *
1937 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
1938 *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
1939 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
1940 *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
1941 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
1942 *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
1943 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
1944 *	mesh interface
1945 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
1946 *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
1947 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
1948 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
1949 *	elements
1950 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
1951 *	detect compatible mesh peers
1952 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
1953 *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
1954 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
1955 *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
1956 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
1957 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
1958 *	a path discovery in milliseconds
1959 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1960 *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
1961 *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
1962 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1963 *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
1964 *	element
1965 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1966 *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
1967 *	element
1968 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
1969 *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
1970 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
1971 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
1972 *	announcements are transmitted
1973 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
1974 *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
1975 *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
1976 *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
1977 *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
1978 *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
1979 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
1980 *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
1981 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
1982 *	station to establish a peer link
1983 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
1984 *
1985 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1986 *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
1987 *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
1988 *
1989 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
1990 *	PREQs are transmitted.
1991 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
1992 *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
1993 *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
1994 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
1995 *	setting for new peer links.
1996 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
1997 *	after transmitting its beacon.
1998 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
1999 *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2000 *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
 
 
 
2001 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2002 *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2003 *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2004 *      in the mesh path table
2005 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2006 *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2007 *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2008 *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2009 *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2010 */
2011struct mesh_config {
2012	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2013	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2014	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2015	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2016	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2017	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2018	u8 element_ttl;
2019	bool auto_open_plinks;
2020	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2021	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2022	u32 path_refresh_time;
2023	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2024	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2025	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2026	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2027	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2028	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2029	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2030	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2031	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2032	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2033	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2034	s32 rssi_threshold;
2035	u16 ht_opmode;
2036	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2037	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2038	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2039	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2040	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2041	u32 plink_timeout;
2042	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2043};
2044
2045/**
2046 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2047 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2048 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2049 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2050 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2051 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2052 * @path_metric: which metric to use
2053 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2054 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2055 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2056 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2057 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2058 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2059 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2060 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2061 * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2062 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2063 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2064 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2065 *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2066 *	to operate on DFS channels.
2067 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2068 *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2069 *
2070 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2071 */
2072struct mesh_setup {
2073	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2074	const u8 *mesh_id;
2075	u8 mesh_id_len;
2076	u8 sync_method;
2077	u8 path_sel_proto;
2078	u8 path_metric;
2079	u8 auth_id;
2080	const u8 *ie;
2081	u8 ie_len;
2082	bool is_authenticated;
2083	bool is_secure;
2084	bool user_mpm;
2085	u8 dtim_period;
2086	u16 beacon_interval;
2087	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2088	u32 basic_rates;
2089	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2090	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2091	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2092};
2093
2094/**
2095 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2096 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2097 *
2098 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2099 */
2100struct ocb_setup {
2101	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2102};
2103
2104/**
2105 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2106 * @ac: AC identifier
2107 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2108 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2109 *	1..32767]
2110 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2111 *	1..32767]
2112 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 
2113 */
2114struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2115	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2116	u16 txop;
2117	u16 cwmin;
2118	u16 cwmax;
2119	u8 aifs;
 
2120};
2121
2122/**
2123 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2124 *
2125 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2126 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2127 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2128 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2129 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2130 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2131 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2132 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2133 * in the wiphy structure.
2134 *
2135 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2136 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2137 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2138 *
2139 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2140 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2141 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2142 * to userspace.
2143 */
2144
2145/**
2146 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2147 * @ssid: the SSID
2148 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2149 */
2150struct cfg80211_ssid {
2151	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2152	u8 ssid_len;
2153};
2154
2155/**
2156 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2157 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2158 *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2159 *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2160 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2161 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2162 *	userspace will be notified of that
2163 */
2164struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2165	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2166	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2167	bool aborted;
2168};
2169
2170/**
2171 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2172 *
2173 * @short_bssid: short ssid to scan for
2174 * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2175 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2176 *	 which the above info relvant to
2177 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2178 * @short_ssid_valid: short_ssid is valid and can be used
2179 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2180 *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
 
2181 */
2182struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2183	u32 short_ssid;
2184	u32 channel_idx;
2185	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2186	bool unsolicited_probe;
2187	bool short_ssid_valid;
2188	bool psc_no_listen;
 
2189};
2190
2191/**
2192 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2193 *
2194 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2195 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2196 * @channels: channels to scan on.
2197 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2198 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2199 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2200 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2201 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2202 *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2203 *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2204 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2205 *	%duration field.
2206 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2207 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2208 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2209 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2210 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2211 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2212 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2213 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2214 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2215 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2216 *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2217 *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2218 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2219 *	true if this is the second scan request
2220 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2221 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2222 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
 
 
2223 */
2224struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2225	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2226	int n_ssids;
2227	u32 n_channels;
2228	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2229	const u8 *ie;
2230	size_t ie_len;
2231	u16 duration;
2232	bool duration_mandatory;
2233	u32 flags;
2234
2235	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2236
2237	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2238
2239	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2240	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2241	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2242
2243	/* internal */
2244	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2245	unsigned long scan_start;
2246	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2247	bool notified;
2248	bool no_cck;
2249	bool scan_6ghz;
2250	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2251	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
 
2252
2253	/* keep last */
2254	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2255};
2256
2257static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2258{
2259	int i;
2260
2261	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2262	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2263		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2264		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2265	}
2266}
2267
2268/**
2269 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2270 *
2271 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2272 *	or no match (RSSI only)
2273 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2274 *	or no match (RSSI only)
2275 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2276 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2277 *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support
2278 *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2279 *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2280 *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2281 *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2282 *	corresponding matchset.
2283 */
2284struct cfg80211_match_set {
2285	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2286	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2287	s32 rssi_thold;
2288	s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2289};
2290
2291/**
2292 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2293 *
2294 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2295 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2296 *	infinite loop.
2297 *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2298 *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2299 */
2300struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2301	u32 interval;
2302	u32 iterations;
2303};
2304
2305/**
2306 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2307 *
2308 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2309 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2310 */
2311struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2312	enum nl80211_band band;
2313	s8 delta;
2314};
2315
2316/**
2317 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2318 *
2319 * @reqid: identifies this request.
2320 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2321 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2322 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2323 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2324 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2325 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2326 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2327 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2328 *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2329 *	(others are filtered out).
2330 *	If ommited, all results are passed.
2331 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2332 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2333 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2334 * @dev: the interface
2335 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2336 * @channels: channels to scan
2337 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2338 *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2339 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2340 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2341 *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2342 *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2343 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2344 *	index must be executed first.
2345 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2346 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2347 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2348 *	owned by a particular socket)
2349 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2350 * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2351 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2352 *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2353 *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2354 *	supported.
2355 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2356 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2357 *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2358 *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2359 *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2360 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2361 *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2362 *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2363 *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2364 *	comparisions.
2365 */
2366struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2367	u64 reqid;
2368	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2369	int n_ssids;
2370	u32 n_channels;
2371	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2372	const u8 *ie;
2373	size_t ie_len;
2374	u32 flags;
2375	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2376	int n_match_sets;
2377	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2378	u32 delay;
2379	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2380	int n_scan_plans;
2381
2382	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2383	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2384
2385	bool relative_rssi_set;
2386	s8 relative_rssi;
2387	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2388
2389	/* internal */
2390	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2391	struct net_device *dev;
2392	unsigned long scan_start;
2393	bool report_results;
2394	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2395	u32 owner_nlportid;
2396	bool nl_owner_dead;
2397	struct list_head list;
2398
2399	/* keep last */
2400	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2401};
2402
2403/**
2404 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2405 *
2406 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2407 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2408 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2409 */
2410enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2411	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2412	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2413	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2414};
2415
2416/**
2417 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2418 * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2419 * @scan_width: scan width that was used
2420 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2421 *	signal type
2422 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2423 *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2424 *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2425 *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2426 *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2427 *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2428 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2429 *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2430 *	by %parent_bssid.
2431 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2432 *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2433 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2434 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2435 */
2436struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2437	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2438	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2439	s32 signal;
2440	u64 boottime_ns;
2441	u64 parent_tsf;
2442	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2443	u8 chains;
2444	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
 
 
 
 
 
2445};
2446
2447/**
2448 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2449 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2450 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2451 * @len: length of the IEs
2452 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2453 * @data: IE data
2454 */
2455struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2456	u64 tsf;
2457	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2458	int len;
2459	bool from_beacon;
2460	u8 data[];
2461};
2462
2463/**
2464 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2465 *
2466 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2467 * for use in scan results and similar.
2468 *
2469 * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2470 * @scan_width: width of the control channel
2471 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2472 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2473 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2474 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2475 *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2476 *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2477 *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2478 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2479 *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2480 *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2481 *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2482 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
 
 
2483 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2484 *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2485 *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2486 *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2487 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2488 *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2489 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2490 *	(multi-BSSID support)
2491 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2492 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2493 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2494 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2495 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
 
 
 
 
 
2496 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2497 */
2498struct cfg80211_bss {
2499	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2500	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2501
2502	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2503	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2504	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2505
2506	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2507	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2508	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2509
2510	s32 signal;
2511
2512	u16 beacon_interval;
2513	u16 capability;
2514
2515	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2516	u8 chains;
2517	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2518
 
 
2519	u8 bssid_index;
2520	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2521
 
 
 
2522	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2523};
2524
2525/**
2526 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2527 * @bss: the bss to search
2528 * @id: the element ID
2529 *
2530 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2531 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2532 * Return: %NULL if not found.
2533 */
2534const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2535
2536/**
2537 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2538 * @bss: the bss to search
2539 * @id: the element ID
2540 *
2541 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2542 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2543 * Return: %NULL if not found.
2544 */
2545static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2546{
2547	return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2548}
2549
2550
2551/**
2552 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2553 *
2554 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2555 * authentication.
2556 *
2557 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2558 *	to it if it needs to keep it.
2559 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2560 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2561 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2562 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2563 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2564 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2565 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2566 *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2567 *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2568 *	transaction sequence number field.
2569 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
 
 
 
 
 
 
2570 */
2571struct cfg80211_auth_request {
2572	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2573	const u8 *ie;
2574	size_t ie_len;
2575	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2576	const u8 *key;
2577	u8 key_len, key_idx;
 
2578	const u8 *auth_data;
2579	size_t auth_data_len;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2580};
2581
2582/**
2583 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
2584 *
2585 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
2586 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
2587 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
2588 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
2589 *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
2590 *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
2591 *	request (connect callback).
2592 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
 
 
 
 
2593 */
2594enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
2595	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
2596	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
2597	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
2598	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
2599	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
 
 
2600};
2601
2602/**
2603 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
2604 *
2605 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2606 * (re)association.
2607 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
2608 *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
2609 *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
2610 *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
 
 
2611 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
2612 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2613 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
2614 * @crypto: crypto settings
2615 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2616 *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2617 *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2618 *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2619 *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2620 *	frame.
2621 * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2622 * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2623 *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2624 * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2625 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
2626 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
2627 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
2628 *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
2629 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
2630 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
2631 *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
2632 *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2633 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
2634 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
 
 
 
 
 
2635 */
2636struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
2637	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2638	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
2639	size_t ie_len;
2640	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2641	bool use_mfp;
2642	u32 flags;
2643	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2644	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2645	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
2646	const u8 *fils_kek;
2647	size_t fils_kek_len;
2648	const u8 *fils_nonces;
2649	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
 
 
 
2650};
2651
2652/**
2653 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
2654 *
2655 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2656 * deauthentication.
2657 *
2658 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from
2659 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
2660 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2661 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
2662 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
2663 *	do not set a deauth frame
2664 */
2665struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
2666	const u8 *bssid;
2667	const u8 *ie;
2668	size_t ie_len;
2669	u16 reason_code;
2670	bool local_state_change;
2671};
2672
2673/**
2674 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
2675 *
2676 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2677 * disassociation.
2678 *
2679 * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from
2680 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
2681 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2682 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
2683 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
2684 *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
2685 */
2686struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
2687	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2688	const u8 *ie;
2689	size_t ie_len;
2690	u16 reason_code;
2691	bool local_state_change;
2692};
2693
2694/**
2695 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
2696 *
2697 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
2698 * method.
2699 *
2700 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
2701 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
2702 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
2703 *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
2704 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
2705 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
2706 *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
2707 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
2708 * @ie_len: length of that
2709 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2710 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
2711 *	after joining
2712 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
2713 *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
2714 *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
2715 *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
2716 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2717 *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2718 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2719 *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2720 *	to operate on DFS channels.
2721 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
2722 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
2723 * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2724 *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2725 * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2726 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
2727 *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
2728 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
2729 */
2730struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
2731	const u8 *ssid;
2732	const u8 *bssid;
2733	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2734	const u8 *ie;
2735	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
2736	u16 beacon_interval;
2737	u32 basic_rates;
2738	bool channel_fixed;
2739	bool privacy;
2740	bool control_port;
2741	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2742	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2743	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2744	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2745	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2746	struct key_params *wep_keys;
2747	int wep_tx_key;
2748};
2749
2750/**
2751 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
2752 *
2753 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
2754 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
2755 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
2756 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
2757 */
2758struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
2759	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
2760	union {
2761		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
2762		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
2763	} param;
2764};
2765
2766/**
2767 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
2768 *
2769 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2770 * authentication and association.
2771 *
2772 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
2773 *	on scan results)
2774 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
2775 *	%NULL if not specified
2776 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
2777 *	results)
2778 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
2779 *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
2780 *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
2781 *	to use.
2782 * @ssid: SSID
2783 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
2784 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2785 * @ie: IEs for association request
2786 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
2787 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
2788 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
2789 * @crypto: crypto settings
2790 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2791 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2792 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2793 * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2794 * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
2795 *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
2796 * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2797 *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2798 * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2799 * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
2800 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
2801 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
2802 *	networks.
2803 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
2804 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2805 *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2806 *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2807 *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2808 *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2809 *	frame.
2810 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
2811 *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
2812 *	data IE.
2813 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
2814 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
2815 *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
2816 *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2817 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
2818 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
2819 *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2820 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
2821 *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
2822 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
2823 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
2824 *	offload of 4-way handshake.
2825 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
2826 *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
2827 *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
2828 */
2829struct cfg80211_connect_params {
2830	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2831	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
2832	const u8 *bssid;
2833	const u8 *bssid_hint;
2834	const u8 *ssid;
2835	size_t ssid_len;
2836	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2837	const u8 *ie;
2838	size_t ie_len;
2839	bool privacy;
2840	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
2841	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2842	const u8 *key;
2843	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2844	u32 flags;
2845	int bg_scan_period;
2846	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2847	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2848	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
2849	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
2850	bool pbss;
2851	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
2852	const u8 *prev_bssid;
2853	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
2854	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
2855	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
2856	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
2857	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
2858	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
2859	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
2860	bool want_1x;
2861	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
2862};
2863
2864/**
2865 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
2866 *
2867 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
2868 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
2869 *
2870 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
2871 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
2872 *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
2873 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
2874 */
2875enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
2876	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
2877	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
2878	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
2879};
2880
2881/**
2882 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
2883 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
2884 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
2885 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
2886 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
2887 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
2888 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
2889 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
2890 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
2891 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
2892 */
2893enum wiphy_params_flags {
2894	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
2895	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
2896	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
2897	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
2898	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
2899	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
2900	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
2901	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
2902	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
2903};
2904
2905#define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
2906
2907/* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
2908#define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
2909#define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
2910
2911/* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
2912#define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
2913
2914/**
2915 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
2916 *
2917 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
2918 * caching.
2919 *
2920 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
2921 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
2922 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
2923 *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
2924 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
2925 *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
2926 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
2927 *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
2928 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
2929 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
2930 *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
2931 *	%NULL).
2932 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
2933 *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
2934 *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
2935 *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
2936 *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
2937 *	used for it expires.
2938 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
2939 *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
2940 *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
2941 *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
2942 *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
2943 */
2944struct cfg80211_pmksa {
2945	const u8 *bssid;
2946	const u8 *pmkid;
2947	const u8 *pmk;
2948	size_t pmk_len;
2949	const u8 *ssid;
2950	size_t ssid_len;
2951	const u8 *cache_id;
2952	u32 pmk_lifetime;
2953	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
2954};
2955
2956/**
2957 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
2958 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
2959 *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
2960 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
2961 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
2962 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
2963 *
2964 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
2965 * memory, free @mask only!
2966 */
2967struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
2968	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
2969	int pattern_len;
2970	int pkt_offset;
2971};
2972
2973/**
2974 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
2975 *
2976 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
2977 * @src: source IP address
2978 * @dst: destination IP address
2979 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
2980 * @src_port: source port
2981 * @dst_port: destination port
2982 * @payload_len: data payload length
2983 * @payload: data payload buffer
2984 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
2985 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
2986 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
2987 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
2988 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
2989 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
2990 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
2991 */
2992struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
2993	struct socket *sock;
2994	__be32 src, dst;
2995	u16 src_port, dst_port;
2996	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
2997	int payload_len;
2998	const u8 *payload;
2999	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3000	u32 data_interval;
3001	u32 wake_len;
3002	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3003	u32 tokens_size;
3004	/* must be last, variable member */
3005	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3006};
3007
3008/**
3009 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3010 *
3011 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3012 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3013 *	operating as normal during suspend
3014 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3015 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3016 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3017 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3018 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3019 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3020 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3021 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3022 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3023 *	NULL if not configured.
3024 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3025 */
3026struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3027	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3028	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3029	     rfkill_release;
3030	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3031	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3032	int n_patterns;
3033	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3034};
3035
3036/**
3037 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3038 *
3039 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3040 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3041 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3042 *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3043 * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3044 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3045 */
3046struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3047	int delay;
3048	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3049	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3050	int n_patterns;
3051};
3052
3053/**
3054 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3055 *
3056 * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3057 * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3058 * @n_rules: number of rules
3059 */
3060struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3061	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
3062	int n_rules;
3063};
3064
3065/**
3066 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3067 *
3068 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3069 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3070 *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3071 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3072 *	occurred (in MHz)
3073 */
3074struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3075	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3076	int n_channels;
3077	u32 channels[];
3078};
3079
3080/**
3081 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3082 *
3083 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3084 *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3085 *	match information.
3086 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3087 *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3088 */
3089struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3090	int n_matches;
3091	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3092};
3093
3094/**
3095 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3096 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3097 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3098 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3099 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3100 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3101 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3102 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3103 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3104 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3105 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3106 * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3107 *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3108 *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3109 *	it is.
3110 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3111 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3112 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3113 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3114 */
3115struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3116	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3117	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3118	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3119	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3120	s32 pattern_idx;
3121	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3122	const void *packet;
3123	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3124};
3125
3126/**
3127 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3128 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3129 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3130 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3131 * @kek_len: length of kek
3132 * @kck_len length of kck
3133 * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3134 */
3135struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3136	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3137	u32 akm;
3138	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3139};
3140
3141/**
3142 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3143 *
3144 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3145 *
3146 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3147 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3148 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3149 */
3150struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3151	u16 md;
3152	const u8 *ie;
3153	size_t ie_len;
3154};
3155
3156/**
3157 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3158 *
3159 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3160 *
3161 * @chan: channel to use
3162 * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required
3163 * @wait: duration for ROC
3164 * @buf: buffer to transmit
3165 * @len: buffer length
3166 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3167 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3168 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3169 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
 
 
 
3170 */
3171struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3172	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3173	bool offchan;
3174	unsigned int wait;
3175	const u8 *buf;
3176	size_t len;
3177	bool no_cck;
3178	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3179	int n_csa_offsets;
3180	const u16 *csa_offsets;
 
3181};
3182
3183/**
3184 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3185 *
3186 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3187 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3188 */
3189struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3190	u8 dscp;
3191	u8 up;
3192};
3193
3194/**
3195 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3196 *
3197 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3198 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3199 */
3200struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3201	u8 low;
3202	u8 high;
3203};
3204
3205/* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3206#define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3207#define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3208#define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3209	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3210
3211/**
3212 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3213 *
3214 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3215 *
3216 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3217 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3218 *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3219 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3220 */
3221struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3222	u8 num_des;
3223	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3224	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3225};
3226
3227/**
3228 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3229 *
3230 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3231 *
3232 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3233 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3234 *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3235 *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3236 */
3237struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3238	u8 master_pref;
3239	u8 bands;
3240};
3241
3242/**
3243 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3244 * configuration
3245 *
3246 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3247 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3248 */
3249enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3250	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3251	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3252};
3253
3254/**
3255 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3256 *
3257 * @filter: the content of the filter
3258 * @len: the length of the filter
3259 */
3260struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3261	const u8 *filter;
3262	u8 len;
3263};
3264
3265/**
3266 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3267 *
3268 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3269 * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3270 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3271 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3272 *	implementation specific.
3273 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3274 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3275 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3276 * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up
3277 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3278 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3279 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3280 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3281 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3282 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3283 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3284 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3285 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3286 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3287 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3288 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3289 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3290 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3291 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3292 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3293 */
3294struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3295	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3296	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3297	u8 publish_type;
3298	bool close_range;
3299	bool publish_bcast;
3300	bool subscribe_active;
3301	u8 followup_id;
3302	u8 followup_reqid;
3303	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3304	u32 ttl;
3305	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3306	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3307	bool srf_include;
3308	const u8 *srf_bf;
3309	u8 srf_bf_len;
3310	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3311	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3312	int srf_num_macs;
3313	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3314	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3315	u8 num_tx_filters;
3316	u8 num_rx_filters;
3317	u8 instance_id;
3318	u64 cookie;
3319};
3320
3321/**
3322 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3323 *
3324 * @aa: authenticator address
3325 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3326 * @pmk: the PMK material
3327 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3328 *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3329 *	holds PMK-R0.
3330 */
3331struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3332	const u8 *aa;
3333	u8 pmk_len;
3334	const u8 *pmk;
3335	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3336};
3337
3338/**
3339 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3340 *
3341 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3342 *
3343 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3344 *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3345 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3346 *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3347 *	authentication response command interface.
3348 * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3349 *	authentication response command interface.
3350 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3351 *	authentication request event interface.
3352 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3353 *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3354 *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3355 *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3356 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3357 */
3358struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3359	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3360	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3361	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3362	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3363	u16 status;
3364	const u8 *pmkid;
 
3365};
3366
3367/**
3368 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3369 *
3370 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3371 *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3372 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3373 *	answered
3374 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3375 *	successfully answered
3376 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3377 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3378 * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3379 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3380 *	of how much time the responder was busy
3381 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3382 *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3383 *	the responder
3384 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3385 *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3386 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3387 */
3388struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3389	u32 filled;
3390	u32 success_num;
3391	u32 partial_num;
3392	u32 failed_num;
3393	u32 asap_num;
3394	u32 non_asap_num;
3395	u64 total_duration_ms;
3396	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3397	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3398	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3399};
3400
3401/**
3402 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3403 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3404 *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3405 *	reason than just "failure"
3406 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3407 *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3408 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3409 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3410 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3411 *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3412 *	by the responder
3413 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3414 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3415 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3416 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3417 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3418 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3419 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3420 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3421 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3422 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3423 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3424 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3425 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3426 *	the square root of the variance)
3427 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3428 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3429 *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3430 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3431 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3432 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3433 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3434 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3435 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3436 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3437 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3438 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3439 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3440 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3441 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3442 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3443 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3444 */
3445struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3446	const u8 *lci;
3447	const u8 *civicloc;
3448	unsigned int lci_len;
3449	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3450	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3451	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3452	s16 burst_index;
3453	u8 busy_retry_time;
3454	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3455	u8 burst_duration;
3456	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3457	s32 rssi_avg;
3458	s32 rssi_spread;
3459	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3460	s64 rtt_avg;
3461	s64 rtt_variance;
3462	s64 rtt_spread;
3463	s64 dist_avg;
3464	s64 dist_variance;
3465	s64 dist_spread;
3466
3467	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3468	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3469	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3470	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3471	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3472	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3473	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3474	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3475	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
3476	    dist_avg_valid:1,
3477	    dist_variance_valid:1,
3478	    dist_spread_valid:1;
3479};
3480
3481/**
3482 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3483 * @addr: address of the peer
3484 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3485 *	measurement was made)
3486 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3487 * @status: status of the measurement
3488 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3489 *	reporting partial results always set this flag
3490 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3491 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3492 *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3493 *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
 
3494 */
3495struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3496	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3497	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3498
3499	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3500
3501	u8 final:1,
3502	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
3503
3504	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3505
3506	union {
3507		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3508	};
3509};
3510
3511/**
3512 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
3513 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
3514 * @preamble: frame preamble to use
3515 * @burst_period: burst period to use
3516 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
3517 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
3518 * @burst_duration: burst duration
3519 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
3520 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
3521 * @request_lci: request LCI information
3522 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
3523 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
3524 *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3525 *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3526 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
3527 *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3528 *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3529 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
3530 *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
3531 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
3532 *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
3533 *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
3534 *
3535 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
3536 */
3537struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
3538	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
3539	u16 burst_period;
3540	u8 requested:1,
3541	   asap:1,
3542	   request_lci:1,
3543	   request_civicloc:1,
3544	   trigger_based:1,
3545	   non_trigger_based:1,
3546	   lmr_feedback:1;
3547	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3548	u8 burst_duration;
3549	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3550	u8 ftmr_retries;
3551	u8 bss_color;
3552};
3553
3554/**
3555 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
3556 * @addr: MAC address
3557 * @chandef: channel to use
3558 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
3559 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
3560 */
3561struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
3562	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3563	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3564	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
3565	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
3566};
3567
3568/**
3569 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
3570 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
3571 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
3572 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
3573 *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
3574 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
3575 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
3576 *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
3577 *	be taken from the @mac_addr
3578 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
3579 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
3580 *	zero it means there's no timeout
3581 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
3582 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
3583 */
3584struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
3585	u64 cookie;
3586	void *drv_data;
3587	u32 n_peers;
3588	u32 nl_portid;
3589
3590	u32 timeout;
3591
3592	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3593	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3594
3595	struct list_head list;
3596
3597	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[];
3598};
3599
3600/**
3601 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
3602 *
3603 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
3604 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
3605 *
3606 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
3607 *
3608 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
3609 *	has to be done.
3610 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
3611 *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
3612 *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
3613 *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
3614 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
3615 *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
3616 *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
3617 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3618 */
3619struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
3620	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3621	u16 status;
3622	const u8 *ie;
3623	size_t ie_len;
 
 
3624};
3625
3626/**
3627 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
3628 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3629 *	for the entire device
3630 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3631 *	for the given interface
3632 * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
3633 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
3634 *	for these subtypes
3635 */
3636struct mgmt_frame_regs {
3637	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
3638	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
3639};
3640
3641/**
3642 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
3643 *
3644 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
3645 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
3646 *
3647 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
3648 * on success or a negative error code.
3649 *
3650 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
3651 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
3652 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
3653 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
3654 *
3655 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
3656 *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
3657 *	configured for the device.
3658 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
3659 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
3660 *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
3661 *	the device.
3662 *
3663 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
3664 *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
3665 *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
3666 *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
3667 *	also set the address member in the wdev.
3668 *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
3669 *
3670 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
3671 *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
3672 *
3673 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
3674 *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
3675 *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
3676 *
 
 
 
 
 
3677 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
3678 *	when adding a group key.
 
 
3679 *
3680 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
3681 *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
3682 *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
3683 *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
3684 *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
 
 
 
3685 *
3686 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
3687 *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist.
 
 
 
3688 *
3689 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface
 
3690 *
3691 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface
 
3692 *
3693 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface
 
3694 *
3695 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
3696 *
3697 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
3698 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
3699 *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
3700 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
3701 *
3702 * @add_station: Add a new station.
3703 * @del_station: Remove a station
3704 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
3705 *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
3706 *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
3707 *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
3708 *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
3709 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
3710 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3711 *
3712 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
3713 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
3714 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
3715 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
3716 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3717 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
3718 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3719 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
3720 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3721 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
3722 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3723 *
3724 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
3725 *
3726 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
3727 *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
3728 *	set, and which to leave alone.
3729 *
3730 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
3731 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3732 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
3733 *
3734 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
3735 *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
3736 *	join the mesh instead.
3737 *
3738 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
3739 *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
3740 *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
3741 *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
3742 *
3743 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
3744 *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
3745 *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
3746 *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
3747 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
3748 *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
3749 *
3750 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
3751 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3752 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
3753 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3754 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
3755 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3756 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
3757 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3758 *
3759 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
3760 *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
3761 *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
3762 *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
3763 *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
3764 *	was received.
3765 *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
3766 *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
3767 *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
3768 *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
3769 *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
3770 *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
3771 *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
3772 *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
3773 *	indication of requesting reassociation.
3774 *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
3775 *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
3776 *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3777 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
3778 *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
3779 *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
3780 *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
3781 *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
3782 *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
3783 *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
3784 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3785 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
3786 *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
3787 *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
3788 *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
3789 *
3790 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
3791 *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
3792 *	to a merge.
3793 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3794 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
3795 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3796 *
3797 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
3798 *	MESH mode)
3799 *
3800 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
3801 *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
3802 *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
3803 *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
3804 *
3805 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
3806 *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
3807 *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
3808 *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
3809 *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
3810 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
3811 *	return 0 if successful
3812 *
3813 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
3814 *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
3815 *
3816 * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
3817 *
3818 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
3819 *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
3820 *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
3821 *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
3822 *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
3823 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
3824 *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
3825 *	the duration value.
3826 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
3827 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
3828 *	frame on another channel
3829 *
3830 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
3831 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
3832 *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
3833 *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
3834 *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
3835 *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
3836 *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
3837 *
3838 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
3839 *
3840 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
3841 *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
3842 *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
3843 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
3844 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
3845 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
3846 *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
3847 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
3848 *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
3849 *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
3850 *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
3851 *	disabled.)
3852 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
3853 *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
3854 *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
3855 *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
3856 *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
3857 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
3858 *	thresholds.
3859 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
3860 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
3861 *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
3862 *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
3863 *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
3864 *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
3865 *	stop (when this method returns 0).
3866 *
3867 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
3868 *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
3869 *
3870 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3871 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3872 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3873 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3874 *
3875 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3876 *
3877 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
3878 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
3879 *
3880 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
3881 *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
3882 *
3883 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
3884 *
3885 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
3886 *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
3887 *	current monitoring channel.
3888 *
3889 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
3890 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
3891 *
3892 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
3893 *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
3894 *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
3895 *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
3896 *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
3897 *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
3898 *
3899 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
3900 *
3901 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
3902 *	was finished on another phy.
3903 *
3904 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
3905 *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
3906 *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
3907 *
3908 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
3909 *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
3910 *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
3911 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
3912 *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
3913 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
3914 *
3915 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
3916 *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
3917 *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
3918 *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
3919 *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
3920 *	as soon as possible.
3921 *
3922 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
3923 *
3924 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
3925 *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
3926 *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
3927 *
3928 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
3929 *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
3930 *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
3931 *	account.
3932 *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
3933 *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
3934 *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
3935 *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
3936 *	rejected)
3937 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
3938 *
3939 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
3940 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3941 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
3942 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3943 *
3944 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3945 *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3946 *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
3947 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3948 *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3949 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
3950 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
3951 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
3952 *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
3953 *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
3954 *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
3955 *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
3956 *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
3957 *	provided @nan_func.
3958 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
3959 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
3960 *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
3961 *	All other parameters must be ignored.
3962 *
3963 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
3964 *
3965 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
3966 *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
3967 *
3968 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
3969 *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
3970 *	upon which the driver should clear it.
3971 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3972 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
3973 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3974 *
3975 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
3976 *     user space
3977 *
3978 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
3979 *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
3980 *
3981 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
3982 *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
3983 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
3984 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
3985 *
3986 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
3987 *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
3988 *	DH IE through this interface.
3989 *
3990 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
3991 *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
3992 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
3993 *	This callback may sleep.
3994 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
3995 *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
3996 *
3997 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3998 */
3999struct cfg80211_ops {
4000	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4001	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4002	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4003
4004	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4005						  const char *name,
4006						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4007						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4008						  struct vif_params *params);
4009	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4010				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4011	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4012				       struct net_device *dev,
4013				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4014				       struct vif_params *params);
4015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4016	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4017			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
4018			   struct key_params *params);
4019	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4020			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
4021			   void *cookie,
4022			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4023	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4024			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr);
 
4025	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4026				   struct net_device *netdev,
4027				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4028	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4029					struct net_device *netdev,
4030					u8 key_index);
4031	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4032					  struct net_device *netdev,
 
4033					  u8 key_index);
4034
4035	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4036			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4037	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4038				 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info);
4039	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
 
4040
4041
4042	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4043			       const u8 *mac,
4044			       struct station_parameters *params);
4045	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4046			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4047	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4048				  const u8 *mac,
4049				  struct station_parameters *params);
4050	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4051			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4052	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4053				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4054
4055	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4056			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4057	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4058			       const u8 *dst);
4059	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4060				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4061	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4062			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4063	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4064			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4065			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4066	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4067			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4068	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4069			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4070			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4071	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4072				struct net_device *dev,
4073				struct mesh_config *conf);
4074	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4075				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4076				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4077	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4078			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4079			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4080	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4081
4082	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4083			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4084	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4085
4086	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4087			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4088
 
 
 
4089	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4090				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4091
4092	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4093					     struct net_device *dev,
4094					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4095
4096	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4097				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4098
4099	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4100			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4101	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4102
4103	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4104			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4105	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4106			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4107	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4108			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4109	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4110			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4111
4112	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4113			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4114	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4115					 struct net_device *dev,
4116					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4117					 u32 changed);
4118	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4119			      u16 reason_code);
4120
4121	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4122			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4123	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4124
4125	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4126				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4127
4128	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4129
4130	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4131				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4132	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4133				int *dbm);
4134
4135	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4136
4137#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4138	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4139				void *data, int len);
4140	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4141				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4142				 void *data, int len);
4143#endif
4144
4145	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4146				    struct net_device *dev,
 
4147				    const u8 *peer,
4148				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4149
4150	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4151			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4152
4153	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4154			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4155	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4156			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4157	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4158
4159	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4160				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4161				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4162				     unsigned int duration,
4163				     u64 *cookie);
4164	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4165					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4166					    u64 cookie);
4167
4168	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4169			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4170			   u64 *cookie);
4171	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4172				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4173				       u64 cookie);
4174
4175	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4176				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4177
4178	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4179				       struct net_device *dev,
4180				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4181
4182	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4183					     struct net_device *dev,
4184					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4185
4186	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4187				      struct net_device *dev,
4188				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4189
4190	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4191						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4192						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4193
4194	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4195	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4196
4197	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4198				struct net_device *dev,
4199				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4200	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4201				   u64 reqid);
4202
4203	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4204				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4205
4206	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4207			     const u8 *peer, u8 action_code,  u8 dialog_token,
4208			     u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability,
4209			     bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
 
4210	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4211			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4212
4213	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4214				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4215
4216	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4217				  struct net_device *dev,
4218				  u16 noack_map);
4219
4220	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4221			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
 
4222			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4223
4224	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4225				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4226	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4227				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4228
4229	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4230			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4231
4232	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4233					 struct net_device *dev,
4234					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4235					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4236	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4237				struct net_device *dev);
4238	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4239				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4240	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4241				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4242				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4243				    u16 duration);
4244	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4245				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4246	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4247				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4248
4249	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4250				  struct net_device *dev,
4251				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4252
4253	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4254			       struct net_device *dev,
4255			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4256
4257	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
 
4258				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4259
4260	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4261			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4262			     u16 admitted_time);
4263	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4264			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4265
4266	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4267				       struct net_device *dev,
4268				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4269				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4270	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4271					      struct net_device *dev,
4272					      const u8 *addr);
4273	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4274			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4275	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4276	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4277				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4278	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4279			       u64 cookie);
4280	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4281				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4282				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4283				   u32 changes);
4284
4285	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4286					    struct net_device *dev,
4287					    const bool enabled);
4288
4289	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4290				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4291				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4292
4293	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4294			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4295	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4296			   const u8 *aa);
4297	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4298				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4299
4300	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4301				   struct net_device *dev,
4302				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4303				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4304				   const bool noencrypt,
4305				   u64 *cookie);
4306
4307	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4308				struct net_device *dev,
4309				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4310
4311	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4312			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4313	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4314			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4315	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4316				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4317	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4318				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4319	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4320				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4321	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4322				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4323	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4324				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4325};
4326
4327/*
4328 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4329 * and registration/helper functions
4330 */
4331
4332/**
4333 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4334 *
4335 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4336 *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB.
4337 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4338 *	wiphy at all
4339 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4340 *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4341 *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4342 *	reason to override the default
4343 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4344 *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4345 *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4346 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4347 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4348 *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4349 *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4350 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4351 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4352 *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4353 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4354 *	firmware.
4355 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4356 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4357 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4358 *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4359 *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4360 *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4361 *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4362 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4363 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4364 *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4365 *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4366 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4367 *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4368 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4369 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4370 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4371 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4372 *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4373 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation
4374 *	before connection.
4375 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4376 */
4377enum wiphy_flags {
4378	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
4379	/* use hole at 1 */
4380	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
4381	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
4382	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
4383	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
4384	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
4385	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
4386	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
4387	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
4388	/* use hole at 11 */
4389	/* use hole at 12 */
4390	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
4391	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
4392	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
4393	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
4394	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
4395	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
4396	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
4397	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
4398	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
4399	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
4400	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
4401	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP		= BIT(24),
 
4402};
4403
4404/**
4405 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4406 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4407 * @types: interface types (bits)
4408 */
4409struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4410	u16 max;
4411	u16 types;
4412};
4413
4414/**
4415 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
4416 *
4417 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
4418 * combinations it supports concurrently.
4419 *
4420 * Examples:
4421 *
4422 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
4423 *
4424 *    .. code-block:: c
4425 *
4426 *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
4427 *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4428 *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, },
4429 *	};
4430 *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
4431 *		.limits = limits1,
4432 *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
4433 *		.max_interfaces = 2,
4434 *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
4435 *	};
4436 *
4437 *
4438 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
4439 *
4440 *    .. code-block:: c
4441 *
4442 *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
4443 *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
4444 *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
4445 *	};
4446 *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
4447 *		.limits = limits2,
4448 *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
4449 *		.max_interfaces = 8,
4450 *		.num_different_channels = 1,
4451 *	};
4452 *
4453 *
4454 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
4455 *
4456 *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
4457 *
4458 *    .. code-block:: c
4459 *
4460 *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
4461 *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4462 *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
4463 *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
4464 *	};
4465 *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
4466 *		.limits = limits3,
4467 *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
4468 *		.max_interfaces = 4,
4469 *		.num_different_channels = 2,
4470 *	};
4471 *
4472 */
4473struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
4474	/**
4475	 * @limits:
4476	 * limits for the given interface types
4477	 */
4478	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
4479
4480	/**
4481	 * @num_different_channels:
4482	 * can use up to this many different channels
4483	 */
4484	u32 num_different_channels;
4485
4486	/**
4487	 * @max_interfaces:
4488	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
4489	 */
4490	u16 max_interfaces;
4491
4492	/**
4493	 * @n_limits:
4494	 * number of limitations
4495	 */
4496	u8 n_limits;
4497
4498	/**
4499	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
4500	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
4501	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
4502	 */
4503	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
4504
4505	/**
4506	 * @radar_detect_widths:
4507	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
4508	 */
4509	u8 radar_detect_widths;
4510
4511	/**
4512	 * @radar_detect_regions:
4513	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
4514	 */
4515	u8 radar_detect_regions;
4516
4517	/**
4518	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
4519	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
4520	 *
4521	 * = 0
4522	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
4523	 * > 0
4524	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
4525	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
4526	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
4527	 */
4528	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
4529};
4530
4531struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
4532	u16 tx, rx;
4533};
4534
4535/**
4536 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
4537 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
4538 *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
4539 *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
4540 *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
4541 *	packet should be preserved in that case
4542 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
4543 *	(see nl80211.h)
4544 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
4545 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
4546 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
4547 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
4548 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
4549 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
4550 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
4551 */
4552enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
4553	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
4554	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
4555	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
4556	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
4557	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
4558	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
4559	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
4560	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
4561	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
4562};
4563
4564struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
4565	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
4566	u32 data_payload_max;
4567	u32 data_interval_max;
4568	u32 wake_payload_max;
4569	bool seq;
4570};
4571
4572/**
4573 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
4574 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
4575 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
4576 *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4577 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4578 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4579 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4580 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
4581 *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
4582 *	scheduled scans.
4583 *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
4584 *	details.
4585 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
4586 */
4587struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
4588	u32 flags;
4589	int n_patterns;
4590	int pattern_max_len;
4591	int pattern_min_len;
4592	int max_pkt_offset;
4593	int max_nd_match_sets;
4594	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
4595};
4596
4597/**
4598 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
4599 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
4600 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
4601 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
4602 *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4603 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4604 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4605 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4606 */
4607struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
4608	int n_rules;
4609	int max_delay;
4610	int n_patterns;
4611	int pattern_max_len;
4612	int pattern_min_len;
4613	int max_pkt_offset;
4614};
4615
4616/**
4617 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
4618 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
4619 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
4620 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
4621 *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
4622 */
4623enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
4624	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
4625	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
4626	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
4627};
4628
4629/**
4630 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
4631 *
4632 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
4633 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
4634 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
4635 *
4636 */
4637enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
4638	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
4639	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
4640	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
4641};
4642
4643/**
4644 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
4645 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
4646 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
4647 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
4648 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
4649 */
4650
4651struct sta_opmode_info {
4652	u32 changed;
4653	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
4654	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
4655	u8 rx_nss;
4656};
4657
4658#define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
4659
4660/**
4661 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
4662 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
4663 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
4664 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
4665 *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
4666 *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
4667 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
4668 *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
4669 *	dumpit calls.
4670 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
4671 *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
4672 *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
4673 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
4674 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
4675 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
4676 * are used with dump requests.
4677 */
4678struct wiphy_vendor_command {
4679	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
4680	u32 flags;
4681	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4682		    const void *data, int data_len);
4683	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4684		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
4685		      unsigned long *storage);
4686	const struct nla_policy *policy;
4687	unsigned int maxattr;
4688};
4689
4690/**
4691 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
4692 * @iftype: interface type
4693 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4694 *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
4695 *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
4696 *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
4697 *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
4698 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4699 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
 
 
4700 */
4701struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
4702	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
4703	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
4704	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
4705	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
 
 
4706};
4707
4708/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4709 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
4710 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
4711 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
4712 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
 
4713 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
4714 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
4715 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
4716 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
4717 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
4718 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
4719 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
4720 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
4721 *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
4722 *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
4723 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
4724 *	not limited)
4725 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4726 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4727 */
4728struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
4729	unsigned int max_peers;
4730	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
4731	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
4732
4733	struct {
4734		u32 preambles;
4735		u32 bandwidths;
4736		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
4737		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
4738		u8 supported:1,
4739		   asap:1,
4740		   non_asap:1,
4741		   request_lci:1,
4742		   request_civicloc:1,
4743		   trigger_based:1,
4744		   non_trigger_based:1;
4745	} ftm;
4746};
4747
4748/**
4749 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
4750 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
4751 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
4752 *
4753 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
4754 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
4755 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4756 */
4757struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
4758	u16 iftypes_mask;
4759	const u32 *akm_suites;
4760	int n_akm_suites;
4761};
4762
 
 
4763/**
4764 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
4765 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
4766 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
4767 *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
4768 *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
4769 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
4770 *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
4771 *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
4772 *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
4773 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
4774 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
4775 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
4776 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
4777 *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
4778 *	iftype_akm_suites.
4779 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4780 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
4781 *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
4782 *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
4783 *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
4784 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
4785 *	suites are specified separately.
4786 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
4787 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
4788 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
4789 *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
4790 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
4791 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
4792 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
4793 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
4794 *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
4795 *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
4796 *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
4797 *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
4798 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
4799 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
4800 *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
4801 *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
4802 *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
4803 *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
4804 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
4805 *	unregister hardware
4806 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
4807 *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
4808 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
4809 *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
4810 *	(see below).
4811 * @wext: wireless extension handlers
4812 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
4813 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
4814 *	must be set by driver
4815 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
4816 *	list single interface types.
4817 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
4818 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
4819 *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
4820 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
4821 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
4822 *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
4823 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
4824 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
4825 *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
4826 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
4827 *	this variable determines its size
4828 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
4829 *	any given scan
4830 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
4831 *	the device can run concurrently.
4832 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
4833 *	for in any given scheduled scan
4834 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
4835 *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
4836 *	supported.
4837 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
4838 *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
4839 *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
4840 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
4841 *	scans
4842 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
4843 *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
4844 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
4845 *	single scan plan supported by the device.
4846 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
4847 *	scan plan supported by the device.
4848 * @coverage_class: current coverage class
4849 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
4850 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
4851 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
4852 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
4853 *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
4854 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
4855 *
4856 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
4857 *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
4858 *	type
4859 *
4860 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4861 *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4862 *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
4863 *
4864 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4865 *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4866 *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
4867 *
4868 * @probe_resp_offload:
4869 *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
4870 *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
4871 *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
4872 *
4873 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
4874 *	may request, if implemented.
4875 *
4876 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
4877 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
4878 *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
4879 *	to the suspend() operation instead.
4880 *
4881 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
4882 * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
4883 *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4884 * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
4885 *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4886 *
4887 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
4888 *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
4889 *
4890 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
4891 *	supports for ACL.
4892 *
4893 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4894 *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
4895 *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
4896 *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
4897 *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
4898 *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
4899 *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
4900 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4901 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4902 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
4903 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
4904 *	capabilities are specified separately.
4905 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
4906 *
4907 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
4908 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
4909 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
4910 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
4911 *
4912 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
4913 *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
4914 *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
4915 *	some cases, but may not always reach.
4916 *
4917 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
4918 *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
4919 *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
4920 *	infinite.
4921 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
4922 *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
4923 *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
4924 *
4925 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
4926 *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
4927 *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
4928 *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
4929 *
4930 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
4931 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
4932 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
4933 *
4934 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
4935 *	wake_tx_queue
4936 *
4937 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
4938 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
4939 *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
4940 *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
4941 *
4942 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
4943 *
4944 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
4945 *	device has
4946 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4947 *	supported by the driver for each vif
4948 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4949 *	supported by the driver for each peer
4950 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
4951 *	long/short retry configuration
4952 *
4953 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
4954 *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
4955 *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
4956 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
4957 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4958 */
4959struct wiphy {
4960	struct mutex mtx;
4961
4962	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
4963
4964	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
4965	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
4966
4967	struct mac_address *addresses;
4968
4969	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
4970
4971	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
4972	int n_iface_combinations;
4973	u16 software_iftypes;
4974
4975	u16 n_addresses;
4976
4977	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
4978	u16 interface_modes;
4979
4980	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
4981
4982	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
4983	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
4984
4985	u32 ap_sme_capa;
4986
4987	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
4988
4989	int bss_priv_size;
4990	u8 max_scan_ssids;
4991	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
4992	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
4993	u8 max_match_sets;
4994	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
4995	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
4996	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
4997	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
4998	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
4999
5000	int n_cipher_suites;
5001	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5002
5003	int n_akm_suites;
5004	const u32 *akm_suites;
5005
5006	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5007	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5008
5009	u8 retry_short;
5010	u8 retry_long;
5011	u32 frag_threshold;
5012	u32 rts_threshold;
5013	u8 coverage_class;
5014
5015	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5016	u32 hw_version;
5017
5018#ifdef CONFIG_PM
5019	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5020	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5021#endif
5022
5023	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5024
5025	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5026
5027	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5028	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5029
5030	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5031
5032	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5033	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5034
5035	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5036	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5037
5038	const void *privid;
5039
5040	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5041
5042	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5043			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5044
5045	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5046
5047	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5048
5049	struct device dev;
5050
5051	bool registered;
5052
5053	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5054
5055	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5056	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5057
5058	struct list_head wdev_list;
5059
5060	possible_net_t _net;
5061
5062#ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5063	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5064#endif
5065
5066	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5067
5068	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5069	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5070	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5071
5072	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5073
5074	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5075
5076	u32 bss_select_support;
5077
5078	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5079
5080	u32 txq_limit;
5081	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5082	u32 txq_quantum;
5083
5084	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5085
5086	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5087	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5088
5089	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5090
5091	struct {
5092		u64 peer, vif;
5093		u8 max_retry;
5094	} tid_config_support;
5095
5096	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5097
5098	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5099
5100	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5101
 
 
 
 
 
 
5102	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5103};
5104
5105static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5106{
5107	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5108}
5109
5110static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5111{
5112	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5113}
5114
5115/**
5116 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5117 *
5118 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5119 * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5120 */
5121static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5122{
5123	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5124	return &wiphy->priv;
5125}
5126
5127/**
5128 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5129 *
5130 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5131 * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5132 */
5133static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5134{
5135	BUG_ON(!priv);
5136	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5137}
5138
5139/**
5140 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5141 *
5142 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5143 * @dev: The device to parent it to
5144 */
5145static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5146{
5147	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5148}
5149
5150/**
5151 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5152 *
5153 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5154 * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5155 */
5156static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5157{
5158	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5159}
5160
5161/**
5162 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5163 *
5164 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5165 * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5166 */
5167static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5168{
5169	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5170}
5171
5172/**
5173 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5174 *
5175 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5176 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5177 * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5178 *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5179 *
5180 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5181 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5182 *
5183 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5184 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5185 */
5186struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5187			   const char *requested_name);
5188
5189/**
5190 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5191 *
5192 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5193 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5194 *
5195 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5196 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5197 *
5198 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5199 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5200 */
5201static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5202				      int sizeof_priv)
5203{
5204	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5205}
5206
5207/**
5208 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5209 *
5210 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5211 *
5212 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5213 */
5214int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5215
5216/* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5217#define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5218
5219/**
5220 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5221 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5222 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5223 *
5224 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5225 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5226 */
5227#define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
5228        rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5229
5230/**
5231 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5232 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5233 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5234 *
5235 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5236 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5237 */
5238#define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
5239        rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5240
5241/**
5242 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5243 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5244 */
5245const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5246
5247/**
5248 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5249 *
5250 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5251 *
5252 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5253 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5254 * request that is being handled.
5255 */
5256void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5257
5258/**
5259 * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5260 *
5261 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5262 */
5263void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5264
5265/* internal structs */
5266struct cfg80211_conn;
5267struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5268struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5269struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5270
5271/**
5272 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5273 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5274 *
5275 * This is mostly exposed so it can be done around registering and
5276 * unregistering netdevs that aren't created through cfg80211 calls,
5277 * since that requires locking in cfg80211 when the notifiers is
5278 * called, but that cannot differentiate which way it's called.
 
 
5279 *
5280 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
 
 
 
5281 */
5282static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5283	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
5284{
5285	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
5286	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
5287}
5288
5289/**
5290 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
5291 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
5292 */
5293static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5294	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
5295{
5296	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
5297	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
5298}
5299
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5300/**
5301 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
5302 *
5303 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
5304 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
5305 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
5306 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
5307 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
5308 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
5309 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
5310 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
5311 *
5312 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
5313 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
5314 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
5315 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
5316 *
5317 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
5318 * @iftype: interface type
5319 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
5320 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
5321 *	for the notifier
5322 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
5323 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
5324 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
5325 *	wireless device if it has no netdev
5326 * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5327 * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track
5328 *	the user-set channel definition.
5329 * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to
5330 *	track the channel to be used for AP later
5331 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5332 * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5333 * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5334 * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5335 * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5336 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
5337 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
5338 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
5339 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
5340 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
5341 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
5342 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
5343 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
5344 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
5345 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
5346 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
5347 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
5348 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
5349 *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
5350 *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
5351 *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
5352 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
5353 * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list
5354 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
5355 *	need to propagate the update to the driver
5356 * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers
5357 *	and some API functions require it held
5358 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
5359 *	beacons, 0 when not valid
5360 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
5361 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
5362 *	the P2P Device.
5363 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
5364 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
5365 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
5366 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
5367 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
5368 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
5369 *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
5370 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
5371 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
5372 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
5373 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
5374 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
5375 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
5376 * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID
5377 * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel
5378 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
5379 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
5380 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
5381 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
 
5382 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
5383 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
5384 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
5385 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
5386 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
5387 *	unprotected beacon report
 
 
 
5388 */
5389struct wireless_dev {
5390	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5391	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5392
5393	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
5394	struct list_head list;
5395	struct net_device *netdev;
5396
5397	u32 identifier;
5398
5399	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
5400	spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock;
5401	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
5402
5403	struct mutex mtx;
5404
5405	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
5406
5407	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
5408
5409	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
5410	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5411	u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len;
5412	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
5413	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
5414	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
5415	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
5416
5417	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
5418	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5419
5420	struct list_head event_list;
5421	spinlock_t event_lock;
5422
5423	struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */
5424	struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
5425	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
5426
5427	bool ibss_fixed;
5428	bool ibss_dfs_possible;
5429
5430	bool ps;
5431	int ps_timeout;
5432
5433	int beacon_interval;
5434
5435	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
5436
5437	u32 owner_nlportid;
5438	bool nl_owner_dead;
5439
 
5440	bool cac_started;
5441	unsigned long cac_start_time;
5442	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
5443
5444#ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5445	/* wext data */
5446	struct {
5447		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
5448		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
5449		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
5450		const u8 *ie;
5451		size_t ie_len;
5452		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5453		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5454		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5455		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
5456		bool prev_bssid_valid;
5457	} wext;
5458#endif
5459
5460	struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config;
 
5461
5462	struct list_head pmsr_list;
5463	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
5464	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
5465
5466	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5467};
5468
5469static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5470{
5471	if (wdev->netdev)
5472		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
5473	return wdev->address;
5474}
5475
5476static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5477{
5478	if (wdev->netdev)
5479		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
5480	return wdev->is_running;
5481}
5482
5483/**
5484 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
5485 *
5486 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
5487 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
5488 */
5489static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5490{
5491	BUG_ON(!wdev);
5492	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
5493}
5494
5495/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5496 * DOC: Utility functions
5497 *
5498 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
5499 */
5500
5501/**
5502 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
5503 *
5504 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
5505 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
5506 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
5507 */
5508static inline bool
5509ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
5510			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
5511{
5512	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
5513		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
5514}
5515
5516/**
5517 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
5518 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
5519 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
5520 */
5521static inline u32
5522ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5523{
5524	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
5525}
5526
5527/**
5528 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
5529 *
5530 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
5531 * @chan: channel
5532 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
5533 */
5534enum nl80211_chan_width
5535ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
5536
5537/**
5538 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
5539 * @chan: channel number
5540 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5541 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5542 */
5543u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
5544
5545/**
5546 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
5547 * @chan: channel number
5548 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5549 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5550 */
5551static inline int
5552ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
5553{
5554	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
5555}
5556
5557/**
5558 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5559 * @freq: center frequency in KHz
5560 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5561 */
5562int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
5563
5564/**
5565 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5566 * @freq: center frequency in MHz
5567 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5568 */
5569static inline int
5570ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
5571{
5572	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5573}
5574
5575/**
5576 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
5577 * frequency
5578 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5579 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
5580 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5581 */
5582struct ieee80211_channel *
5583ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
5584
5585/**
5586 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
5587 *
5588 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5589 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
5590 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5591 */
5592static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
5593ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
5594{
5595	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5596}
5597
5598/**
5599 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
5600 * @chan: control channel to check
5601 *
5602 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
5603 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
5604 */
5605static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5606{
5607	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
5608		return false;
5609
5610	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
5611}
5612
5613/**
5614 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
5615 *
5616 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5617 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
5618 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
5619 *
5620 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
5621 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
5622 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
5623 * rates in the band's bitrate table.
5624 */
5625const struct ieee80211_rate *
5626ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5627			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
5628
5629/**
5630 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
5631 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5632 * @scan_width: width of the control channel
5633 *
5634 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
5635 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
5636 */
5637u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5638			      enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width);
5639
5640/*
5641 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
5642 *
5643 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
5644 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
5645 */
5646
5647struct radiotap_align_size {
5648	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
5649};
5650
5651struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
5652	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
5653	int n_bits;
5654	uint32_t oui;
5655	uint8_t subns;
5656};
5657
5658struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
5659	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
5660	int n_ns;
5661};
5662
5663/**
5664 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
5665 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
5666 *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
5667 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
5668 *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
5669 *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
5670 *	the beginning of the actual data portion
5671 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
5672 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
5673 *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
5674 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
5675 *	radiotap namespace or not
5676 *
5677 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
5678 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
5679 * @_arg_index: next argument index
5680 * @_arg: next argument pointer
5681 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
5682 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
5683 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
5684 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
5685 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
5686 *	next bitmap word
5687 *
5688 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
5689 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
5690 */
5691
5692struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
5693	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
5694	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
5695	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
5696
5697	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
5698	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
5699
5700	unsigned char *this_arg;
5701	int this_arg_index;
5702	int this_arg_size;
5703
5704	int is_radiotap_ns;
5705
5706	int _max_length;
5707	int _arg_index;
5708	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
5709	int _reset_on_ext;
5710};
5711
5712int
5713ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
5714				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
5715				 int max_length,
5716				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
5717
5718int
5719ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
5720
5721
5722extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
5723extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
5724
5725/**
5726 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
5727 *
5728 * @skb: the frame
5729 *
5730 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
5731 * returns the 802.11 header length.
5732 *
5733 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
5734 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
5735 * 802.11 header.
5736 */
5737unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
5738
5739/**
5740 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
5741 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
5742 * Return: The header length in bytes.
5743 */
5744unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
5745
5746/**
5747 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
5748 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
5749 *	(first byte) will be accessed
5750 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
5751 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
5752 */
5753unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
5754
5755/**
5756 * DOC: Data path helpers
5757 *
5758 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
5759 * functions that help implement the data path for devices
5760 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
5761 */
5762
5763/**
5764 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5765 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5766 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
5767 *	of it being pushed into the SKB
5768 * @addr: the device MAC address
5769 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5770 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
 
5771 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5772 */
5773int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
5774				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5775				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
5776
5777/**
5778 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5779 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5780 * @addr: the device MAC address
5781 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5782 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5783 */
5784static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
5785					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
5786{
5787	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
5788}
5789
5790/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5791 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
5792 *
5793 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
5794 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
5795 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
5796 *
5797 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
5798 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
5799 *	initialized by the caller.
5800 * @addr: The device MAC address.
5801 * @iftype: The device interface type.
5802 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
5803 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5804 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
 
5805 */
5806void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
5807			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5808			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
5809			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5810
5811/**
5812 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
5813 * @skb: the data frame
5814 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
5815 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
5816 */
5817unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
5818				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
5819
5820/**
5821 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
5822 *
5823 * @eid: element ID
5824 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5825 * @len: length of data
5826 * @match: byte array to match
5827 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5828 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
5829 *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
5830 *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
5831 *	the data portion instead.
5832 *
5833 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5834 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5835 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5836 * requested element struct.
5837 *
5838 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5839 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5840 * byte array to match.
5841 */
5842const struct element *
5843cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5844			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5845			 unsigned int match_offset);
5846
5847/**
5848 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
5849 *
5850 * @eid: element ID
5851 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5852 * @len: length of data
5853 * @match: byte array to match
5854 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5855 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
5856 *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
5857 *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
5858 *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
5859 *	the second byte is the IE length.
5860 *
5861 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5862 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5863 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
5864 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5865 * element ID.
5866 *
5867 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5868 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5869 * byte array to match.
5870 */
5871static inline const u8 *
5872cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5873		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5874		       unsigned int match_offset)
5875{
5876	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
5877	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
5878	 */
5879	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
5880		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
5881		return NULL;
5882
5883	return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
5884						match, match_len,
5885						match_offset ?
5886							match_offset - 2 : 0);
5887}
5888
5889/**
5890 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
5891 *
5892 * @eid: element ID
5893 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5894 * @len: length of data
5895 *
5896 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5897 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5898 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5899 * requested element struct.
5900 *
5901 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5902 * having to fit into the given data.
5903 */
5904static inline const struct element *
5905cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5906{
5907	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5908}
5909
5910/**
5911 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
5912 *
5913 * @eid: element ID
5914 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5915 * @len: length of data
5916 *
5917 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5918 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5919 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5920 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5921 *
5922 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5923 * having to fit into the given data.
5924 */
5925static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5926{
5927	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5928}
5929
5930/**
5931 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
5932 *
5933 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5934 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5935 * @len: length of data
5936 *
5937 * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if
5938 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5939 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5940 * requested element struct.
5941 *
5942 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5943 * having to fit into the given data.
5944 */
5945static inline const struct element *
5946cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5947{
5948	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5949					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
5950}
5951
5952/**
5953 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
5954 *
5955 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5956 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5957 * @len: length of data
5958 *
5959 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
5960 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5961 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5962 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5963 *
5964 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5965 * having to fit into the given data.
5966 */
5967static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5968{
5969	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5970				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
5971}
5972
5973/**
5974 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
5975 *
5976 * @oui: vendor OUI
5977 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5978 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5979 * @len: length of data
5980 *
5981 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
5982 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
5983 * return the element structure for the requested element.
5984 *
5985 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
5986 * the given data.
5987 */
5988const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
5989						const u8 *ies,
5990						unsigned int len);
5991
5992/**
5993 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
5994 *
5995 * @oui: vendor OUI
5996 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5997 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5998 * @len: length of data
5999 *
6000 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6001 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6002 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6003 * element ID.
6004 *
6005 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6006 * the given data.
6007 */
6008static inline const u8 *
6009cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6010			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
6011{
6012	return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
6013}
6014
6015/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6016 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
6017 *
6018 * @dev: network device
6019 * @addr: STA MAC address
6020 *
6021 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
6022 * devices upon STA association.
6023 */
6024void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6025
6026/**
6027 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
6028 *
6029 * TODO
6030 */
6031
6032/**
6033 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
6034 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
6035 *	conflicts)
6036 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
6037 *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
6038 *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
6039 *	alpha2.
6040 *
6041 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
6042 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
6043 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
6044 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
6045 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
6046 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
6047 *
6048 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
6049 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
6050 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
6051 *
6052 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6053 * an -ENOMEM.
6054 *
6055 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
6056 */
6057int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
6058
6059/**
6060 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
6061 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6062 * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy
6063 *
6064 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
6065 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
6066 * information.
6067 *
6068 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6069 */
6070int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6071			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6072
6073/**
6074 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
6075 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6076 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6077 *
6078 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
6079 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
6080 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
6081 *
6082 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6083 */
6084int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6085				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6086
6087/**
6088 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
6089 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6090 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
6091 *
6092 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
6093 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
6094 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
6095 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
6096 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
6097 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
6098 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
6099 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
6100 * that called this helper.
6101 */
6102void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6103				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
6104
6105/**
6106 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
6107 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
6108 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
6109 *
6110 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
6111 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
6112 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
6113 * and processed already.
6114 *
6115 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
6116 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
6117 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
6118 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
6119 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
6120 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
6121 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
6122 */
6123const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6124					       u32 center_freq);
6125
6126/**
6127 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
6128 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
6129 *
6130 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
6131 * proper string representation.
6132 */
6133const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
6134
6135/**
6136 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
6137 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
6138 *
6139 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
6140 */
6141bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6142
6143/**
6144 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
6145 *
6146 */
6147
6148/**
6149 * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
6150 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
6151 *
6152 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
6153 * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried.
6154 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
6155 *
6156 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
6157 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
6158 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
6159 *
6160 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6161 * an -ENODATA.
6162 *
6163 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
6164 */
6165int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
6166			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
6167
6168/*
6169 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
6170 * functions and BSS handling helpers
6171 */
6172
6173/**
6174 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
6175 *
6176 * @request: the corresponding scan request
6177 * @info: information about the completed scan
6178 */
6179void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
6180			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6181
6182/**
6183 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
6184 *
6185 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
6186 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6187 */
6188void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6189
6190/**
6191 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6192 *
6193 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6194 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6195 *
6196 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6197 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6198 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6199 */
6200void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6201
6202/**
6203 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6204 *
6205 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6206 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6207 *
6208 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6209 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6210 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6211 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
6212 */
6213void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6214
6215/**
6216 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
6217 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6218 * @data: the BSS metadata
6219 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
6220 * @len: length of the management frame
6221 * @gfp: context flags
6222 *
6223 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6224 * the BSS should be updated/added.
6225 *
6226 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6227 * Or %NULL on error.
6228 */
6229struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6230cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6231			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6232			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6233			       gfp_t gfp);
6234
6235static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6236cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6237				struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6238				enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6239				struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6240				s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6241{
6242	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6243		.chan = rx_channel,
6244		.scan_width = scan_width,
6245		.signal = signal,
6246	};
6247
6248	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6249}
6250
6251static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6252cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6253			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6254			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6255			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6256{
6257	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6258		.chan = rx_channel,
6259		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6260		.signal = signal,
6261	};
6262
6263	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6264}
6265
6266/**
6267 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
6268 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
6269 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
6270 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
6271 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
6272 */
6273static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
6274					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
6275{
6276	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
6277	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
6278	u64 new_bssid_u64;
6279
6280	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
6281
6282	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
6283
6284	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
6285}
6286
6287/**
6288 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
6289 * @element: element to check
6290 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
6291 */
6292bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
6293				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
6294
6295/**
6296 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
6297 * @ie: ies
6298 * @ielen: length of IEs
6299 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
6300 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
6301 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
6302 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
6303 */
6304size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6305			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
6306			      const struct element *sub_elem,
6307			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
6308
6309/**
6310 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
6311 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
6312 *	from a beacon or probe response
6313 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
6314 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
6315 */
6316enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
6317	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
6318	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
6319	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
6320};
6321
6322/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6323 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
6324 *
6325 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6326 * @data: the BSS metadata
6327 * @ftype: frame type (if known)
6328 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
6329 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
6330 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
6331 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
6332 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
6333 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
6334 * @gfp: context flags
6335 *
6336 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6337 * the BSS should be updated/added.
6338 *
6339 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6340 * Or %NULL on error.
6341 */
6342struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6343cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6344			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6345			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6346			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6347			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6348			 gfp_t gfp);
6349
6350static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6351cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6352			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6353			  enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6354			  enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6355			  const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6356			  u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6357			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6358{
6359	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6360		.chan = rx_channel,
6361		.scan_width = scan_width,
6362		.signal = signal,
6363	};
6364
6365	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6366					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6367					gfp);
6368}
6369
6370static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6371cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6372		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6373		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6374		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6375		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6376		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6377{
6378	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6379		.chan = rx_channel,
6380		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6381		.signal = signal,
6382	};
6383
6384	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6385					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6386					gfp);
6387}
6388
6389/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6390 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
6391 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6392 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
6393 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
6394 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
6395 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
6396 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
6397 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
 
 
6398 */
6399struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6400				      struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6401				      const u8 *bssid,
6402				      const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
6403				      enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
6404				      enum ieee80211_privacy privacy);
 
 
 
 
 
6405static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
6406cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6407		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6408		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
6409{
6410	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
6411				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
6412				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
6413}
6414
6415/**
6416 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
6417 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6418 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
6419 *
6420 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6421 */
6422void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6423
6424/**
6425 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
6426 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6427 * @bss: the BSS struct
6428 *
6429 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6430 */
6431void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6432
6433/**
6434 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
6435 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6436 * @bss: the bss to remove
6437 *
6438 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
6439 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
6440 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
6441 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
6442 */
6443void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6444
6445/**
6446 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
6447 *
6448 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
6449 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
6450 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
6451 *
6452 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6453 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
6454 *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
6455 * @iter: the iterator function to call
6456 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
6457 */
6458void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6459		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6460		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6461				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6462				    void *data),
6463		       void *iter_data);
6464
6465static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width
6466cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
6467{
6468	switch (chandef->width) {
6469	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
6470		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5;
6471	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
6472		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10;
6473	default:
6474		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6475	}
6476}
6477
6478/**
6479 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
6480 * @dev: network device
6481 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
6482 * @len: length of the frame data
6483 *
6484 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
6485 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
6486 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
6487 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6488 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6489 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6490 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
6491 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
6492 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
6493 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
6494 *
6495 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6496 */
6497void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6498
6499/**
6500 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
6501 * @dev: network device
6502 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
6503 *
6504 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
6505 * mutex.
6506 */
6507void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6508
6509/**
6510 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
6511 * @dev: network device
6512 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
6513 *	moves to cfg80211 in this call
6514 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
6515 * @len: length of the frame data
6516 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
6517 *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
6518 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
6519 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6520 *
6521 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6522 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6523 *
6524 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6525 */
6526void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
6527			    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6528			    const u8 *buf, size_t len,
6529			    int uapsd_queues,
6530			    const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len);
6531
6532/**
6533 * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association
6534 * @dev: network device
6535 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out.
6536 *
6537 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
 
 
6538 */
6539void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
 
 
 
 
6540
6541/**
6542 * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt
6543 * @dev: network device
6544 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned.
6545 *
6546 * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX,
6547 * an association attempt was abandoned.
6548 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6549 */
6550void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
 
6551
6552/**
6553 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
6554 * @dev: network device
6555 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
6556 * @len: length of the frame data
6557 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
6558 *
6559 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
6560 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
6561 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
6562 * corresponding wdev's mutex.
6563 */
6564void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
6565			   bool reconnect);
6566
6567/**
6568 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
6569 * @dev: network device
6570 * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
6571 * @len: length of the frame data
6572 *
6573 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
6574 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
6575 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
6576 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
6577 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
6578 *
6579 * This function may sleep.
6580 */
6581void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
6582				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6583
6584/**
6585 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
6586 * @dev: network device
6587 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
6588 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
6589 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
6590 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
6591 * @gfp: allocation flags
6592 *
6593 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
6594 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
6595 * primitive.
6596 */
6597void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
6598				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
6599				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
6600
6601/**
6602 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
6603 *
6604 * @dev: network device
6605 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
6606 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
6607 * @gfp: allocation flags
6608 *
6609 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
6610 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
6611 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
6612 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
6613 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
6614 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
6615 */
6616void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6617			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
6618
6619/**
6620 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
6621 * 					candidate
6622 *
6623 * @dev: network device
6624 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
6625 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
6626 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
 
6627 * @gfp: allocation flags
6628 *
6629 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
6630 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
6631 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
6632 */
6633void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
6634		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
6635		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
6636
6637/**
6638 * DOC: RFkill integration
6639 *
6640 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
6641 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
6642 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
6643 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are
6644 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
6645 *
6646 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
6647 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
6648 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
6649 */
6650
6651/**
6652 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
6653 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6654 * @blocked: block status
6655 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
6656 */
6657void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
6658				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
6659
6660static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
6661{
6662	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
6663					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
6664}
6665
6666/**
6667 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
6668 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6669 */
6670void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6671
6672/**
6673 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
6674 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6675 */
6676static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6677{
6678	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
6679}
6680
6681/**
6682 * DOC: Vendor commands
6683 *
6684 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
6685 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
6686 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
6687 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
6688 * the configuration mechanism.
6689 *
6690 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
6691 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an
6692 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
6693 *
6694 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
6695 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
6696 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
6697 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
6698 * managers etc. need.
6699 */
6700
6701struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6702					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6703					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6704					   int approxlen);
6705
6706struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6707					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6708					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6709					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6710					   unsigned int portid,
6711					   int vendor_event_idx,
6712					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
6713
6714void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
6715
6716/**
6717 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
6718 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6719 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6720 *	be put into the skb
6721 *
6722 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6723 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6724 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
6725 *
6726 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
6727 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6728 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6729 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6730 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6731 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
6732 * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
6733 *
6734 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
6735 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
6736 *
6737 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6738 */
6739static inline struct sk_buff *
6740cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6741{
6742	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6743					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
6744}
6745
6746/**
6747 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
6748 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6749 *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
6750 *
6751 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6752 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
6753 * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
6754 * skb regardless of the return value.
6755 *
6756 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6757 */
6758int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
6759
6760/**
6761 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
6762 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6763 *
6764 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
6765 * Valid to call only there.
6766 */
6767unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6768
6769/**
6770 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
6771 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6772 * @wdev: the wireless device
6773 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6774 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6775 *	be put into the skb
6776 * @gfp: allocation flags
6777 *
6778 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6779 * vendor-specific multicast group.
6780 *
6781 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6782 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6783 * attribute.
6784 *
6785 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6786 * skb to send the event.
6787 *
6788 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6789 */
6790static inline struct sk_buff *
6791cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6792			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6793{
6794	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6795					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6796					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6797}
6798
6799/**
6800 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
6801 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6802 * @wdev: the wireless device
6803 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6804 * @portid: port ID of the receiver
6805 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6806 *	be put into the skb
6807 * @gfp: allocation flags
6808 *
6809 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
6810 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
6811 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
6812 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
6813 *
6814 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6815 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6816 * attribute.
6817 *
6818 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6819 * skb to send the event.
6820 *
6821 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6822 */
6823static inline struct sk_buff *
6824cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6825				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6826				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
6827				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6828{
6829	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6830					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6831					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6832}
6833
6834/**
6835 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
6836 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
6837 * @gfp: allocation flags
6838 *
6839 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6840 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
6841 */
6842static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6843{
6844	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6845}
6846
6847#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
6848/**
6849 * DOC: Test mode
6850 *
6851 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
6852 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
6853 * factory programming.
6854 *
6855 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more
6856 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
6857 */
6858
6859/**
6860 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
6861 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6862 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6863 *	be put into the skb
6864 *
6865 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6866 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6867 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
6868 *
6869 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
6870 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6871 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6872 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6873 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6874 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
6875 * must not modify the skb in any other way.
6876 *
6877 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
6878 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
6879 *
6880 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6881 */
6882static inline struct sk_buff *
6883cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6884{
6885	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6886					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
6887}
6888
6889/**
6890 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
6891 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6892 *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
6893 *
6894 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6895 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
6896 * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
6897 * regardless of the return value.
6898 *
6899 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6900 */
6901static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
6902{
6903	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
6904}
6905
6906/**
6907 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
6908 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6909 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6910 *	be put into the skb
6911 * @gfp: allocation flags
6912 *
6913 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6914 * testmode multicast group.
6915 *
6916 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
6917 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
6918 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
6919 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
6920 * in any other way.
6921 *
6922 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
6923 * skb to send the event.
6924 *
6925 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6926 */
6927static inline struct sk_buff *
6928cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
6929{
6930	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6931					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
6932					  approxlen, gfp);
6933}
6934
6935/**
6936 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
6937 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6938 *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
6939 * @gfp: allocation flags
6940 *
6941 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6942 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
6943 * consumes it.
6944 */
6945static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6946{
6947	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6948}
6949
6950#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
6951#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
6952#else
6953#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
6954#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
6955#endif
6956
6957/**
6958 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
6959 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
6960 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
6961 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
6962 *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
6963 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
6964 *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
6965 *	status for a FILS connection.
6966 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6967 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
6968 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
6969 *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6970 */
6971struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
6972	const u8 *kek;
6973	size_t kek_len;
6974	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
6975	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
6976	const u8 *pmk;
6977	size_t pmk_len;
6978	const u8 *pmkid;
6979};
6980
6981/**
6982 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
6983 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6984 *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6985 *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
6986 *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
6987 *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
6988 *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
6989 *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
6990 *	case.
6991 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL)
6992 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
6993 *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
6994 *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
6995 *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
6996 *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
6997 *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
6998 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
6999 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
7000 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7001 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
7002 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
7003 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7004 *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7005 *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7006 *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7007 *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7008 *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7009 */
7010struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
7011	int status;
7012	const u8 *bssid;
7013	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7014	const u8 *req_ie;
7015	size_t req_ie_len;
7016	const u8 *resp_ie;
7017	size_t resp_ie_len;
7018	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7019	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7020};
7021
7022/**
7023 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7024 *
7025 * @dev: network device
7026 * @params: connection response parameters
7027 * @gfp: allocation flags
7028 *
7029 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7030 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7031 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
7032 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
7033 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
7034 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7035 */
7036void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
7037			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
7038			   gfp_t gfp);
7039
7040/**
7041 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7042 *
7043 * @dev: network device
7044 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7045 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
7046 *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
7047 *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
7048 *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
7049 *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
7050 *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
7051 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7052 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7053 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7054 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7055 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7056 *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7057 *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7058 *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7059 *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7060 *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7061 *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7062 *	case.
7063 * @gfp: allocation flags
7064 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7065 *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7066 *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7067 *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7068 *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7069 *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7070 *
7071 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7072 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7073 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
7074 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
7075 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7076 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7077 */
7078static inline void
7079cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7080		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
7081		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
7082		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
7083		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7084{
7085	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
7086
7087	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
7088	params.status = status;
7089	params.bssid = bssid;
7090	params.bss = bss;
7091	params.req_ie = req_ie;
7092	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
7093	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
7094	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
7095	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
7096
7097	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
7098}
7099
7100/**
7101 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7102 *
7103 * @dev: network device
7104 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7105 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7106 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7107 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7108 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7109 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7110 *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7111 *	the real status code for failures.
7112 * @gfp: allocation flags
7113 *
7114 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7115 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7116 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
7117 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7118 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7119 */
7120static inline void
7121cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7122			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
7123			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
7124			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
7125{
7126	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
7127			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
7128			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
7129}
7130
7131/**
7132 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
7133 *
7134 * @dev: network device
7135 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7136 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7137 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7138 * @gfp: allocation flags
7139 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
7140 *
7141 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
7142 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
7143 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
7144 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
7145 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
7146 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7147 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7148 */
7149static inline void
7150cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7151			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
7152			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7153{
7154	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
7155			     gfp, timeout_reason);
7156}
7157
7158/**
7159 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
7160 *
7161 * @channel: the channel of the new AP
7162 * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set)
7163 * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set)
7164 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7165 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7166 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7167 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7168 * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7169 */
7170struct cfg80211_roam_info {
7171	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
7172	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7173	const u8 *bssid;
7174	const u8 *req_ie;
7175	size_t req_ie_len;
7176	const u8 *resp_ie;
7177	size_t resp_ie_len;
7178	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7179};
7180
7181/**
7182 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
7183 *
7184 * @dev: network device
7185 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
7186 * @gfp: allocation flags
7187 *
7188 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
7189 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
7190 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
7191 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
7192 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
7193 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
7194 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
7195 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
7196 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
7197 * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
7198 */
7199void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
7200		     gfp_t gfp);
7201
7202/**
7203 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
7204 *
7205 * @dev: network device
7206 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
 
 
 
7207 * @gfp: allocation flags
7208 *
7209 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
7210 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
7211 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
7212 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
7213 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
7214 * indicate the 802.11 association.
 
 
 
7215 */
7216void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7217			      gfp_t gfp);
7218
7219/**
7220 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
7221 *
7222 * @dev: network device
7223 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
7224 * @ie_len: length of IEs
7225 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
7226 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
7227 * @gfp: allocation flags
7228 *
7229 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
7230 * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
7231 */
7232void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
7233			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
7234			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
7235
7236/**
7237 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
7238 * @wdev: wireless device
7239 * @cookie: the request cookie
7240 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7241 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
7242 *	channel
7243 * @gfp: allocation flags
7244 */
7245void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7246			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7247			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
7248
7249/**
7250 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
7251 * @wdev: wireless device
7252 * @cookie: the request cookie
7253 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7254 * @gfp: allocation flags
7255 */
7256void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7257					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7258					gfp_t gfp);
7259
7260/**
7261 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
7262 * @wdev: wireless device
7263 * @cookie: the requested cookie
7264 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
7265 * @gfp: allocation flags
7266 */
7267void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7268			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
7269
7270/**
7271 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
7272 *
7273 * @sinfo: the station information
7274 * @gfp: allocation flags
7275 */
7276int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7277
7278/**
7279 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
7280 * @sinfo: the station information
7281 *
7282 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
7283 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
7284 * the stack.)
7285 */
7286static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
7287{
7288	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
7289}
7290
7291/**
7292 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
7293 *
7294 * @dev: the netdev
7295 * @mac_addr: the station's address
7296 * @sinfo: the station information
7297 * @gfp: allocation flags
7298 */
7299void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7300		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7301
7302/**
7303 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7304 * @dev: the netdev
7305 * @mac_addr: the station's address
7306 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
7307 * @gfp: allocation flags
7308 */
7309void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7310			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7311
7312/**
7313 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7314 *
7315 * @dev: the netdev
7316 * @mac_addr: the station's address
7317 * @gfp: allocation flags
7318 */
7319static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
7320				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
7321{
7322	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
7323}
7324
7325/**
7326 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
7327 *
7328 * @dev: the netdev
7329 * @mac_addr: the station's address
7330 * @reason: the reason for connection failure
7331 * @gfp: allocation flags
7332 *
7333 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
7334 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
7335 * for some reasons, this function is called.
7336 *
7337 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
7338 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
7339 */
7340void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7341			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
7342			  gfp_t gfp);
7343
7344/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7345 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7346 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7347 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
7348 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7349 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7350 * @len: length of the frame data
7351 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7352 *
7353 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7354 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7355 *
7356 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7357 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7358 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7359 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7360 */
7361bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm,
7362			  const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7363
7364/**
7365 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7366 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7367 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
7368 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7369 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7370 * @len: length of the frame data
7371 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7372 *
7373 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7374 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7375 *
7376 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7377 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7378 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7379 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7380 */
7381static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
7382				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7383				    u32 flags)
7384{
7385	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len,
7386				    flags);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7387}
7388
7389/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7390 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
7391 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7392 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
7393 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7394 * @len: length of the frame data
7395 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7396 * @gfp: context flags
7397 *
7398 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
7399 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
7400 * transmission attempt.
7401 */
7402void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7403			     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7404
7405/**
7406 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
7407 *                                   port frames
7408 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7409 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
7410 * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
7411 * @len: length of the frame data
7412 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7413 * @gfp: context flags
7414 *
7415 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
7416 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
7417 * the transmission attempt.
7418 */
7419void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7420				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
7421				     gfp_t gfp);
7422
7423/**
7424 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
7425 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7426 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
7427 *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
7428 *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
7429 *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
7430 *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
7431 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
 
7432 *
7433 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
7434 * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
7435 * control port frames over nl80211.
7436 *
7437 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
7438 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
7439 *
7440 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
7441 */
7442bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev,
7443			      struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted);
7444
7445/**
7446 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
7447 * @dev: network device
7448 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
7449 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
7450 * @gfp: context flags
7451 *
7452 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
7453 * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
7454 */
7455void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7456			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
7457			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
7458
7459/**
7460 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
7461 * @dev: network device
7462 * @peer: peer's MAC address
7463 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
7464 *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
7465 *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
7466 * @gfp: context flags
7467 */
7468void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7469				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
7470
7471/**
7472 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
7473 * @dev: network device
7474 * @peer: peer's MAC address
7475 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
7476 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
7477 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
7478 * @gfp: context flags
7479 *
7480 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
7481 * given interval is exceeded.
7482 */
7483void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7484			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
7485
7486/**
7487 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
7488 * @dev: network device
7489 * @gfp: context flags
7490 *
7491 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
7492 */
7493void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
7494
7495/**
7496 * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
7497 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7498 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
 
7499 * @gfp: context flags
7500 *
7501 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
7502 */
7503void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7504			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7505
7506/**
7507 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
7508 * @dev: network device
7509 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
7510 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
7511 * @gfp: context flags
7512 *
7513 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
7514 * frame.
7515 */
7516void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
7517				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
7518				       gfp_t gfp);
7519
7520/**
7521 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
7522 * @netdev: network device
7523 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7524 * @event: type of event
7525 * @gfp: context flags
7526 *
7527 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
7528 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
7529 * also by full-MAC drivers.
7530 */
7531void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7532			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7533			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
7534
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7535
7536/**
7537 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
7538 * @dev: network device
7539 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
7540 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
7541 * @gfp: allocation flags
7542 */
7543void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7544			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
7545
7546/**
7547 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
7548 * @dev: network device
7549 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
7550 * @bssid: BSSID of AP
7551 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
7552 * @gfp: allocation flags
7553 */
7554void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
7555				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
7556
7557/**
7558 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
7559 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7560 * @addr: the transmitter address
7561 * @gfp: context flags
7562 *
7563 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7564 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
7565 * sender.
7566 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7567 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7568 */
7569bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7570				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7571
7572/**
7573 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
7574 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7575 * @addr: the transmitter address
7576 * @gfp: context flags
7577 *
7578 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7579 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
7580 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
7581 * station to avoid event flooding.
7582 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7583 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7584 */
7585bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7586					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7587
7588/**
7589 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
7590 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
7591 * @addr: the address of the peer
7592 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
7593 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
7594 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
7595 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
7596 * @gfp: allocation flags
7597 */
7598void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7599			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
7600			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
7601
7602/**
7603 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
7604 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7605 * @frame: the frame
7606 * @len: length of the frame
7607 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
7608 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7609 *
7610 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7611 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7612 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7613 */
7614void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
7615				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
7616
7617/**
7618 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
7619 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7620 * @frame: the frame
7621 * @len: length of the frame
7622 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
7623 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7624 *
7625 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7626 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7627 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7628 */
7629static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7630					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
7631					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
7632{
7633	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
7634					sig_dbm);
7635}
7636
7637/**
7638 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
7639 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7640 * @chandef: the channel definition
7641 * @iftype: interface type
7642 *
7643 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7644 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
7645 */
7646bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7647			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7648			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7649
7650/**
7651 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
7652 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7653 * @chandef: the channel definition
7654 * @iftype: interface type
7655 *
7656 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7657 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
7658 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
7659 * more permissive conditions.
7660 *
7661 * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
7662 */
7663bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7664				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7665				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7666
7667/*
7668 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
7669 * @dev: the device which switched channels
7670 * @chandef: the new channel definition
 
 
7671 *
7672 * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable
7673 * driver context!
7674 */
7675void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7676			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
 
7677
7678/*
7679 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
7680 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
7681 * @chandef: the future channel definition
 
7682 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
7683 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
 
7684 *
7685 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
7686 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
7687 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
7688 */
7689void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7690				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7691				       u8 count, bool quiet);
 
7692
7693/**
7694 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
7695 *
7696 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
7697 * @band: band pointer to fill
7698 *
7699 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7700 */
7701bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
7702				       enum nl80211_band *band);
7703
7704/**
7705 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
7706 *
7707 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7708 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
7709 *
7710 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7711 */
7712bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7713					  u8 *op_class);
7714
7715/**
7716 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
7717 *
7718 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7719 *
7720 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
7721 */
7722static inline u32
7723ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
7724{
7725	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
7726}
7727
7728/*
7729 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
7730 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
7731 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
7732 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
7733 *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
7734 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
7735 * @gfp: allocation flags
7736 *
7737 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
7738 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
7739 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
7740 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
7741 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
7742 */
7743void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7744				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7745				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7746
7747/*
7748 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
7749 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
7750 *
7751 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
7752 */
7753u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
7754
7755/**
7756 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
7757 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
7758 *
7759 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
7760 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
7761 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
7762 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
7763 * is unbound from the driver.
7764 *
7765 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
7766 */
7767void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
7768
7769/**
7770 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
7771 * @dev: the netdev to register
7772 *
7773 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
7774 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
7775 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
7776 * instead as well.
7777 *
7778 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
7779 */
7780int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
7781
7782/**
7783 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
7784 * @dev: the netdev to register
7785 *
7786 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
7787 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
7788 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
7789 * usable instead as well.
7790 *
7791 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
7792 */
7793static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
7794{
 
7795	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
 
7796}
7797
7798/**
7799 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
7800 * @ies: FT IEs
7801 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
7802 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
7803 * @ric_ies: RIC IE
7804 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
7805 */
7806struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
7807	const u8 *ies;
7808	size_t ies_len;
7809	const u8 *target_ap;
7810	const u8 *ric_ies;
7811	size_t ric_ies_len;
7812};
7813
7814/**
7815 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
7816 * @netdev: network device
7817 * @ft_event: IE information
7818 */
7819void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7820		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
7821
7822/**
7823 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
7824 * @ies: the input IE buffer
7825 * @len: the input length
7826 * @attr: the attribute ID to find
7827 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
7828 *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
7829 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
7830 *
7831 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
7832 * copies its contents to the given buffer.
7833 *
7834 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
7835 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
7836 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
7837 */
7838int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
7839			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
7840			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
7841
7842/**
7843 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
7844 * @ies: the IE buffer
7845 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7846 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7847 *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7848 *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7849 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7850 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
7851 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
7852 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7853 *
7854 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7855 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7856 * split.
7857 *
7858 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7859 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7860 *
7861 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7862 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7863 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7864 *
7865 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7866 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7867 * of the buffer should be used.
7868 */
7869size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7870			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
7871			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
7872			      size_t offset);
7873
7874/**
7875 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
7876 * @ies: the IE buffer
7877 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7878 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7879 *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7880 *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7881 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7882 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7883 *
7884 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7885 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7886 * split.
7887 *
7888 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7889 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7890 *
7891 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7892 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7893 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7894 *
7895 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7896 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7897 * of the buffer should be used.
7898 */
7899static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7900					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
7901{
7902	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
7903}
7904
7905/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7906 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
7907 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
7908 * @wakeup: the wakeup report
7909 * @gfp: allocation flags
7910 *
7911 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
7912 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
7913 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
7914 * else caused the wakeup.
7915 */
7916void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7917				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7918				   gfp_t gfp);
7919
7920/**
7921 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
7922 *
7923 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
7924 * @gfp: allocation flags
7925 *
7926 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
7927 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
7928 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
7929 */
7930void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
7931
7932/**
7933 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
7934 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7935 *
7936 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
7937 */
7938unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7939
7940/**
7941 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
7942 *
7943 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7944 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7945 *
7946 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
7947 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
7948 * the interface combinations.
7949 */
7950int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7951				struct iface_combination_params *params);
7952
7953/**
7954 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
7955 *
7956 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7957 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7958 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
7959 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
7960 *
7961 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
7962 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
7963 * purposes.
7964 */
7965int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7966			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
7967			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
7968					    void *data),
7969			       void *data);
7970
7971/*
7972 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
7973 *
7974 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7975 * @wdev: wireless device
7976 * @gfp: context flags
7977 *
7978 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
7979 * disconnected.
7980 *
7981 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
7982 */
7983void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7984			 gfp_t gfp);
7985
7986/**
7987 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
7988 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
7989 *
7990 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
7991 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
7992 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
7993 * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
7994 *
7995 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
7996 * the driver while the function is running.
7997 */
7998void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7999
8000/**
8001 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
8002 *
8003 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8004 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8005 *
8006 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8007 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8008 */
8009static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8010					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8011{
8012	u8 *ft_byte;
8013
8014	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
8015	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
8016}
8017
8018/**
8019 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
8020 *
8021 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8022 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8023 *
8024 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8025 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8026 */
8027static inline bool
8028wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8029			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8030{
8031	u8 ft_byte;
8032
8033	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
8034	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
8035}
8036
8037/**
8038 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
8039 * @f: NAN function that should be freed
8040 *
8041 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
8042 */
8043void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
8044
8045/**
8046 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
8047 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
8048 *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
8049 *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
8050 *	 result.
8051 *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
8052 * @inst_id: the local instance id
8053 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
8054 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
8055 * @info_len: the length of the &info
8056 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
8057 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
8058 */
8059struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
8060	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
8061	u8 inst_id;
8062	u8 peer_inst_id;
8063	const u8 *addr;
8064	u8 info_len;
8065	const u8 *info;
8066	u64 cookie;
8067};
8068
8069/**
8070 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
8071 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
8072 * @match: match notification parameters
8073 * @gfp: allocation flags
8074 *
8075 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
8076 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
8077 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
8078 */
8079void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8080			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
8081
8082/**
8083 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
8084 *
8085 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
8086 * @inst_id: the local instance id
8087 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
8088 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
8089 * @gfp: allocation flags
8090 *
8091 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
8092 */
8093void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8094				  u8 inst_id,
8095				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
8096				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
8097
8098/* ethtool helper */
8099void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
8100
8101/**
8102 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
8103 * @netdev: network device
8104 * @params: External authentication parameters
8105 * @gfp: allocation flags
8106 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
8107 */
8108int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
8109				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
8110				   gfp_t gfp);
8111
8112/**
8113 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
8114 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
8115 * @req: the original measurement request
8116 * @result: the result data
8117 * @gfp: allocation flags
8118 */
8119void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8120			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
8121			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
8122			  gfp_t gfp);
8123
8124/**
8125 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
8126 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
8127 * @req: the original measurement request
8128 * @gfp: allocation flags
8129 *
8130 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
8131 * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
8132 */
8133void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8134			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
8135			    gfp_t gfp);
8136
8137/**
8138 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
8139 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8140 * @iftype: interface type
8141 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
8142 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
8143 *
8144 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
8145 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
8146 * check_swif is '1'.
8147 */
8148bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
8149			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
8150
8151
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8152/* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
8153
8154/* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
8155
8156#define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
8157	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8158#define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8159	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8160#define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8161	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8162#define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8163	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8164#define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8165	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8166#define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8167	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8168#define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8169	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8170#define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8171	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8172#define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8173	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8174
8175#define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
8176	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8177#define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
8178	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8179
8180#define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8181	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
8182
8183#define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8184	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8185
8186#if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
8187#define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
8188#else
8189#define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
8190({									\
8191	if (0)								\
8192		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
8193	0;								\
8194})
8195#endif
8196
8197/*
8198 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
8199 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
8200 * file/line information and a backtrace.
8201 */
8202#define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8203	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
8204
8205/**
8206 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
8207 * @netdev: network device
8208 * @owe_info: peer's owe info
8209 * @gfp: allocation flags
8210 */
8211void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8212				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
8213				    gfp_t gfp);
8214
8215/**
8216 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
8217 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8218 */
8219void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8220
8221#endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
v6.8
   1/* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
   2#ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
   3#define __NET_CFG80211_H
   4/*
   5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface
   6 *
   7 * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
   9 * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
  10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2021, 2023 Intel Corporation
  11 */
  12
  13#include <linux/ethtool.h>
  14#include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
  15#include <linux/netdevice.h>
  16#include <linux/debugfs.h>
  17#include <linux/list.h>
  18#include <linux/bug.h>
  19#include <linux/netlink.h>
  20#include <linux/skbuff.h>
  21#include <linux/nl80211.h>
  22#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  23#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  24#include <linux/net.h>
  25#include <linux/rfkill.h>
  26#include <net/regulatory.h>
  27
  28/**
  29 * DOC: Introduction
  30 *
  31 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
  32 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
  33 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
  34 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
  35 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
  36 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
  37 *
  38 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
  39 * use restrictions.
  40 */
  41
  42
  43/**
  44 * DOC: Device registration
  45 *
  46 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
  47 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
  48 * described below.
  49 *
  50 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
  51 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
  52 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
  53 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
  54 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
  55 * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the
  56 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
  57 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
  58 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
  59 *
  60 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
  61 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
  62 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
  63 */
  64
  65struct wiphy;
  66
  67/*
  68 * wireless hardware capability structures
  69 */
  70
  71/**
  72 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
  73 *
  74 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
  75 *
  76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
  77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
  78 *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
  79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this
  80 *	channel.
  81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
  82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
  83 *	is not permitted.
  84 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
  85 *	is not permitted.
  86 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
  87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
  88 *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
  89 *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
  90 *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
  91 *	restrictions.
  92 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
  93 *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
  94 *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
  95 *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
  96 *	restrictions.
  97 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
  98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
  99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
 100 *	on this channel.
 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
 102 *	on this channel.
 103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
 104 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
 105 *	on this channel.
 106 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
 107 *	on this channel.
 108 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
 109 *	on this channel.
 110 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
 111 *	on this channel.
 112 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
 113 *	on this channel.
 114 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
 115 *	this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
 116 *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
 117 *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
 118 *	restrictions.
 119 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
 120 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT
 121 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection with VLP AP
 122 *	not permitted using this channel
 123 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection with AFC AP
 124 *	not permitted using this channel
 125 */
 126enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
 127	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
 128	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
 129	IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD		= 1<<2,
 130	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
 131	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
 132	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
 133	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
 134	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
 135	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
 136	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
 137	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
 138	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
 139	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
 140	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
 141	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
 142	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
 143	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
 144	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
 145	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
 146	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ	= 1<<19,
 147	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT		= 1<<20,
 148	IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT	= 1<<21,
 149	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT= 1<<22,
 150	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT= 1<<23,
 151};
 152
 153#define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
 154	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
 155
 156#define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
 157#define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
 158
 159/**
 160 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
 161 *
 162 * This structure describes a single channel for use
 163 * with cfg80211.
 164 *
 165 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
 166 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
 167 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
 168 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
 169 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
 170 *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
 171 * @band: band this channel belongs to.
 172 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
 173 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
 174 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
 175 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
 176 *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
 177 *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
 178 * @orig_mag: internal use
 179 * @orig_mpwr: internal use
 180 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
 181 *	on this channel.
 182 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
 183 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
 184 * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm)
 185 */
 186struct ieee80211_channel {
 187	enum nl80211_band band;
 188	u32 center_freq;
 189	u16 freq_offset;
 190	u16 hw_value;
 191	u32 flags;
 192	int max_antenna_gain;
 193	int max_power;
 194	int max_reg_power;
 195	bool beacon_found;
 196	u32 orig_flags;
 197	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
 198	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
 199	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
 200	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
 201	s8 psd;
 202};
 203
 204/**
 205 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
 206 *
 207 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
 208 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
 209 * different bands/PHY modes.
 210 *
 211 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
 212 *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
 213 *	with CCK rates.
 214 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
 215 *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
 216 *	core code when registering the wiphy.
 217 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
 218 *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
 219 *	core code when registering the wiphy.
 220 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
 221 *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
 222 *	core code when registering the wiphy.
 223 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
 224 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
 225 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
 226 */
 227enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
 228	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
 229	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
 230	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
 231	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
 232	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
 233	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
 234	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
 235};
 236
 237/**
 238 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
 239 *
 240 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
 241 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
 242 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
 243 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
 244 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
 245 */
 246enum ieee80211_bss_type {
 247	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
 248	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
 249	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
 250	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
 251	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
 252};
 253
 254/**
 255 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
 256 *
 257 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
 258 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
 259 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
 260 */
 261enum ieee80211_privacy {
 262	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
 263	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
 264	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
 265};
 266
 267#define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
 268	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
 269
 270/**
 271 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
 272 *
 273 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
 274 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
 275 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
 276 * passed around.
 277 *
 278 * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags
 279 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
 280 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
 281 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
 282 *	short preamble is used
 283 */
 284struct ieee80211_rate {
 285	u32 flags;
 286	u16 bitrate;
 287	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
 288};
 289
 290/**
 291 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
 292 *
 293 * @enable: is the feature enabled.
 294 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
 295 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
 296 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
 297 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
 298 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
 299 *	members of the SRG
 300 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
 301 *	used by members of the SRG
 302 */
 303struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
 304	bool enable;
 305	u8 sr_ctrl;
 306	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
 307	u8 min_offset;
 308	u8 max_offset;
 309	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
 310	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
 311};
 312
 313/**
 314 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
 315 *
 316 * @color: the current color.
 317 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
 318 * @partial: define the AID equation.
 319 */
 320struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
 321	u8 color;
 322	bool enabled;
 323	bool partial;
 324};
 325
 326/**
 327 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
 328 *
 329 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 330 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
 331 *
 332 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
 333 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
 334 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
 335 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
 336 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
 337 */
 338struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
 339	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
 340	bool ht_supported;
 341	u8 ampdu_factor;
 342	u8 ampdu_density;
 343	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
 344};
 345
 346/**
 347 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
 348 *
 349 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 350 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
 351 *
 352 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
 353 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
 354 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
 355 */
 356struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
 357	bool vht_supported;
 358	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
 359	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
 360};
 361
 362#define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
 363
 364/**
 365 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
 366 *
 367 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 368 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
 369 *
 370 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
 371 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
 372 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
 373 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
 374 */
 375struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
 376	bool has_he;
 377	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
 378	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
 379	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
 380};
 381
 382/**
 383 * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
 384 *
 385 * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
 386 * and NSS Set field"
 387 *
 388 * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
 389 * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
 390 * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
 391 * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
 392 * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
 393 */
 394struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
 395	union {
 396		struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
 397		struct {
 398			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
 399			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
 400			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
 401		} __packed bw;
 402	} __packed;
 403} __packed;
 404
 405#define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		32
 406
 407/**
 408 * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
 409 *
 410 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 411 * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
 412 *
 413 * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
 414 * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
 415 * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
 416 * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
 417 */
 418struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
 419	bool has_eht;
 420	struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
 421	struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
 422	u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
 423};
 424
 425/* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */
 426#ifdef __CHECKER__
 427/*
 428 * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed
 429 * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot
 430 * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be
 431 * noisy when the pointer is used directly.
 432 */
 433# define __iftd		__attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data)))
 434#else
 435# define __iftd
 436#endif /* __CHECKER__ */
 437
 438/**
 439 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
 440 *
 441 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
 442 * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
 443 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
 444 *
 445 * @types_mask: interface types mask
 446 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
 447 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
 448 *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
 449 * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
 450 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
 451 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
 452 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
 453 */
 454struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
 455	u16 types_mask;
 456	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
 457	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
 458	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
 459	struct {
 460		const u8 *data;
 461		unsigned int len;
 462	} vendor_elems;
 463};
 464
 465/**
 466 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
 467 *
 468 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
 469 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
 470 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
 471 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
 472 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
 473 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
 474 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
 475 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
 476 *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
 477 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
 478 *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
 479 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
 480 *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
 481 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
 482 *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
 483 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
 484 *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
 485 */
 486enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
 487	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
 488	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
 489	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
 490	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
 491	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
 492	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
 493	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
 494	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
 495	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
 496	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
 497	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
 498	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
 499};
 500
 501/**
 502 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
 503 *
 504 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 505 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
 506 *
 507 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
 508 *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
 509 *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
 510 *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
 511 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
 512 *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
 513 */
 514struct ieee80211_edmg {
 515	u8 channels;
 516	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
 517};
 518
 519/**
 520 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
 521 *
 522 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
 523 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
 524 *
 525 * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
 526 * @cap: S1G capabilities information
 527 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
 528 */
 529struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
 530	bool s1g;
 531	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
 532	u8 nss_mcs[5];
 533};
 534
 535/**
 536 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
 537 *
 538 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
 539 * is able to operate in.
 540 *
 541 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
 542 *	in this band.
 543 * @band: the band this structure represents
 544 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
 545 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
 546 *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
 547 *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
 548 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
 549 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
 550 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
 551 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
 552 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
 553 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
 554 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
 555 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
 556 *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
 557 *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
 558 *	iftype_data).
 559 */
 560struct ieee80211_supported_band {
 561	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
 562	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
 563	enum nl80211_band band;
 564	int n_channels;
 565	int n_bitrates;
 566	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
 567	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
 568	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
 569	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
 570	u16 n_iftype_data;
 571	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data;
 572};
 573
 574/**
 575 * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
 576 * @sband: the sband to initialize
 577 * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer
 578 * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array
 579 *
 580 * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot
 581 * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer
 582 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used.
 583 */
 584static inline void
 585_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
 586				 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd,
 587				 u16 n_iftd)
 588{
 589	sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd;
 590	sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd;
 591}
 592
 593/**
 594 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
 595 * @sband: the sband to initialize
 596 * @iftd: the iftype data array
 597 */
 598#define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd)	\
 599	_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd))
 600
 601/**
 602 * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries
 603 * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate
 604 * @i: iterator counter
 605 * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set
 606 */
 607#define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd)				\
 608	for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i];	\
 609	     i < (sband)->n_iftype_data;					\
 610	     i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i])
 611
 612/**
 613 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
 614 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
 615 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
 616 *
 617 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
 618 */
 619static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
 620ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
 621				u8 iftype)
 622{
 623	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data;
 624	int i;
 625
 626	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
 627		return NULL;
 628
 629	if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
 630		iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
 
 631
 632	for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) {
 633		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
 634			return data;
 635	}
 636
 637	return NULL;
 638}
 639
 640/**
 641 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
 642 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
 643 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
 644 *
 645 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
 646 */
 647static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
 648ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
 649			    u8 iftype)
 650{
 651	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
 652		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
 653
 654	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
 655		return &data->he_cap;
 656
 657	return NULL;
 658}
 659
 660/**
 661 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
 662 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
 663 * @iftype: the iftype to search for
 664 *
 665 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
 666 */
 667static inline __le16
 668ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
 669			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
 670{
 671	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
 672		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
 673
 674	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
 675		return 0;
 676
 677	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
 678}
 679
 680/**
 681 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
 682 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
 683 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
 684 *
 685 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
 686 */
 687static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
 688ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
 689			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
 690{
 691	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
 692		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
 693
 694	if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
 695		return &data->eht_cap;
 696
 697	return NULL;
 698}
 699
 700/**
 701 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
 702 *
 703 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
 704 *
 705 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
 706 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
 707 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
 708 *
 709 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
 710 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
 711 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
 712 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
 713 * without affecting other devices.
 714 *
 715 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
 716 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
 717 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
 718 */
 719#ifdef CONFIG_OF
 720void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
 721#else /* CONFIG_OF */
 722static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
 723{
 724}
 725#endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
 726
 727
 728/*
 729 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
 730 */
 731
 732/**
 733 * DOC: Actions and configuration
 734 *
 735 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
 736 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
 737 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
 738 * operations use are described separately.
 739 *
 740 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
 741 * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
 742 *
 743 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
 744 * in a separate chapter.
 745 */
 746
 747#define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
 748				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
 749
 750/**
 751 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
 752 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
 753 *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
 754 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
 755 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
 756 *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
 757 *	determine the address as needed.
 758 *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
 759 *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
 760 **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
 761 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
 762 *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
 763 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
 764 *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
 765 */
 766struct vif_params {
 767	u32 flags;
 768	int use_4addr;
 769	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
 770	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
 771	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
 772};
 773
 774/**
 775 * struct key_params - key information
 776 *
 777 * Information about a key
 778 *
 779 * @key: key material
 780 * @key_len: length of key material
 781 * @cipher: cipher suite selector
 782 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
 783 *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
 784 *	length given by @seq_len.
 785 * @seq_len: length of @seq.
 786 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
 787 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
 788 */
 789struct key_params {
 790	const u8 *key;
 791	const u8 *seq;
 792	int key_len;
 793	int seq_len;
 794	u16 vlan_id;
 795	u32 cipher;
 796	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
 797};
 798
 799/**
 800 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
 801 * @chan: the (control) channel
 802 * @width: channel width
 803 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
 804 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
 805 *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
 806 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
 807 *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
 808 *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
 809 *	parameters are ignored.
 810 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
 811 */
 812struct cfg80211_chan_def {
 813	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
 814	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
 815	u32 center_freq1;
 816	u32 center_freq2;
 817	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
 818	u16 freq1_offset;
 819};
 820
 821/*
 822 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
 823 */
 824struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
 825	struct {
 826		u32 legacy;
 827		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
 828		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
 829		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
 830		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
 831		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
 832		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
 833	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 834};
 835
 836
 837/**
 838 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
 839 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
 840 *	of the peer.
 841 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
 842 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
 843 *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
 844 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
 845 * @retry_long: retry count value
 846 * @retry_short: retry count value
 847 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
 848 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
 849 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
 850 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
 851 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
 852 */
 853struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
 854	bool config_override;
 855	u8 tids;
 856	u64 mask;
 857	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
 858	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
 859	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
 860	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
 861	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
 862	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
 863	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
 864};
 865
 866/**
 867 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
 868 * @peer: Station's MAC address
 869 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
 870 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
 871 */
 872struct cfg80211_tid_config {
 873	const u8 *peer;
 874	u32 n_tid_conf;
 875	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf);
 876};
 877
 878/**
 879 * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
 880 * @macaddr: STA MAC address
 881 * @kek: FILS KEK
 882 * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
 883 * @snonce: STA Nonce
 884 * @anonce: AP Nonce
 885 */
 886struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
 887	const u8 *macaddr;
 888	const u8 *kek;
 889	u8 kek_len;
 890	const u8 *snonce;
 891	const u8 *anonce;
 892};
 893
 894/**
 895 * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping
 896 * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all
 897 *	addresses.
 898 * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
 899 *	Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
 900 */
 901struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp {
 902	const u8 *macaddr;
 903	bool enable;
 904};
 905
 906/**
 907 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
 908 * @chandef: the channel definition
 909 *
 910 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
 911 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
 912 */
 913static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
 914cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
 915{
 916	switch (chandef->width) {
 917	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
 918		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
 919	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
 920		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
 921	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
 922		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
 923			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
 924		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
 925	default:
 926		WARN_ON(1);
 927		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
 928	}
 929}
 930
 931/**
 932 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
 933 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
 934 * @channel: the control channel
 935 * @chantype: the channel type
 936 *
 937 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
 938 */
 939void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
 940			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
 941			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
 942
 943/**
 944 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
 945 * @chandef1: first channel definition
 946 * @chandef2: second channel definition
 947 *
 948 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
 949 * identical, %false otherwise.
 950 */
 951static inline bool
 952cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
 953			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
 954{
 955	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
 956		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
 957		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
 958		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
 959		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
 960}
 961
 962/**
 963 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
 964 *
 965 * @chandef: the channel definition
 966 *
 967 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
 968 */
 969static inline bool
 970cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
 971{
 972	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
 973}
 974
 975/**
 976 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
 977 * @chandef1: first channel definition
 978 * @chandef2: second channel definition
 979 *
 980 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
 981 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
 982 */
 983const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
 984cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
 985			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
 986
 987/**
 988 * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz
 989 * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
 990 *
 991 * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
 992 * is valid. -1 otherwise.
 993 */
 994int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width);
 995
 996/**
 997 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
 998 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
 999 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
1000 */
1001bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1002
1003/**
1004 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
1005 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1006 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1007 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
1008 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
1009 */
1010bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1011			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1012			     u32 prohibited_flags);
1013
1014/**
1015 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
1016 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1017 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1018 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
1019 * Returns:
1020 *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
1021 */
1022int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1023				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1024				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
1025
1026/**
1027 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we
1028 *				 can/need start CAC on such channel
1029 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1030 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1031 *
1032 * Return: true if all channels available and at least
1033 *	   one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE)
1034 */
1035bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1036				 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1037
1038/**
1039 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given
1040 *				   channel definition
1041 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1042 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1043 *
1044 * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition
1045 */
1046unsigned int
1047cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1048			      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1049
1050/**
1051 * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition.
1052 * @msg: the msg to send channel definition
1053 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1054 *
1055 * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error
1056 **/
1057int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1058
1059/**
1060 * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
1061 * @width: the channel width of the channel
1062 *
1063 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
1064 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
1065 *
1066 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
 
 
1067 */
1068static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
1069ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
1070{
1071	switch (width) {
1072	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1073		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
1074	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1075		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
1076	default:
1077		break;
1078	}
1079	return 0;
1080}
1081
1082/**
1083 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
1084 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1085 *
1086 * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
1087 *
1088 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
1089 */
1090static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
1091ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1092{
1093	return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
1094}
1095
1096/**
1097 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
1098 *
1099 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
1100 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
1101 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
1102 *
1103 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1104 *
1105 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
1106 */
1107static inline int
1108ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1109{
1110	switch (chandef->width) {
1111	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1112		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
1113			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1114	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1115		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1116			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1117	default:
1118		break;
1119	}
1120	return chandef->chan->max_power;
1121}
1122
1123/**
1124 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1125 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1126 * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1127 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1128 *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1129 */
1130bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1131				  unsigned long band_mask,
1132				  u32 prohibited_flags);
1133
1134/**
1135 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1136 *
1137 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1138 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1139 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1140 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1141 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1142 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1143 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1144 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1145 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1146 *
1147 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1148 * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1149 */
1150enum survey_info_flags {
1151	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
1152	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
1153	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
1154	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
1155	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
1156	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
1157	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
1158	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
1159	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
1160};
1161
1162/**
1163 * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1164 *
1165 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1166 *	record to report global statistics
1167 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1168 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1169 *	optional
1170 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1171 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1172 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1173 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1174 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1175 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1176 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1177 *
1178 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1179 *
1180 * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1181 * channel duty cycle etc.
1182 */
1183struct survey_info {
1184	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1185	u64 time;
1186	u64 time_busy;
1187	u64 time_ext_busy;
1188	u64 time_rx;
1189	u64 time_tx;
1190	u64 time_scan;
1191	u64 time_bss_rx;
1192	u32 filled;
1193	s8 noise;
1194};
1195
1196#define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES	10
1197
1198/**
1199 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1200 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1201 *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1202 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1203 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1204 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1205 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1206 * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1207 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1208 *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1209 *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1210 *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1211 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1212 *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1213 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1214 *	protocol frames.
1215 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1216 *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1217 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1218 *	port for mac80211
 
 
 
1219 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1220 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1221 *	offload)
1222 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1223 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1224 *
1225 *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1226 *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1227 *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1228 *	  such a scenario.
1229 *
1230 *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1231 *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1232 *
1233 *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1234 *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1235 *
1236 *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1237 *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1238 */
1239struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1240	u32 wpa_versions;
1241	u32 cipher_group;
1242	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1243	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1244	int n_akm_suites;
1245	u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1246	bool control_port;
1247	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1248	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1249	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1250	bool control_port_no_preauth;
 
 
1251	const u8 *psk;
1252	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1253	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1254	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1255};
1256
1257/**
1258 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1259 *
1260 * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1261 * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1262 * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1263 */
1264struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1265	struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1266	u8 index;
1267	bool ema;
1268};
1269
1270/**
1271 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1272 *
1273 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1274 *
1275 * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1276 * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1277 * @elem.len: Length of data.
1278 */
1279struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1280	u8 cnt;
1281	struct {
1282		const u8 *data;
1283		size_t len;
1284	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1285};
1286
1287/**
1288 * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements
1289 *
1290 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1291 *
1292 * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1293 * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements.
1294 * @elem.len: Length of data.
1295 */
1296struct cfg80211_rnr_elems {
1297	u8 cnt;
1298	struct {
1299		const u8 *data;
1300		size_t len;
1301	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1302};
1303
1304/**
1305 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1306 * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1307 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1308 *	or %NULL if not changed
1309 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1310 *	or %NULL if not changed
1311 * @head_len: length of @head
1312 * @tail_len: length of @tail
1313 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1314 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1315 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1316 *	frames or %NULL
1317 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1318 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1319 *	Response frames or %NULL
1320 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1321 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1322 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1323 * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1324 * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements
1325 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1326 *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1327 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1328 *	(measurement type 8)
1329 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1330 *	Token (measurement type 11)
1331 * @lci_len: LCI data length
1332 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1333 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1334 * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1335 *	attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1336 */
1337struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1338	unsigned int link_id;
1339
1340	const u8 *head, *tail;
1341	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1342	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1343	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1344	const u8 *probe_resp;
1345	const u8 *lci;
1346	const u8 *civicloc;
1347	struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1348	struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies;
1349	s8 ftm_responder;
1350
1351	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1352	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1353	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1354	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1355	size_t probe_resp_len;
1356	size_t lci_len;
1357	size_t civicloc_len;
1358	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1359	bool he_bss_color_valid;
1360};
1361
1362struct mac_address {
1363	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1364};
1365
1366/**
1367 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1368 *
1369 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1370 *	entry specified by mac_addr
1371 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1372 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1373 */
1374struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1375	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1376	int n_acl_entries;
1377
1378	/* Keep it last */
1379	struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries);
1380};
1381
1382/**
1383 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1384 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1385 *
1386 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1387 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1388 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1389 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1390 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1391 *	frame headers.
1392 */
1393struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1394	bool update;
1395	u32 min_interval;
1396	u32 max_interval;
1397	size_t tmpl_len;
1398	const u8 *tmpl;
1399};
1400
1401/**
1402 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1403 *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1404 *
1405 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1406 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1407 *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1408 *	scanning
1409 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1410 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1411 */
1412struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1413	bool update;
1414	u32 interval;
1415	size_t tmpl_len;
1416	const u8 *tmpl;
1417};
1418
1419/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1420 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1421 *
1422 * Used to configure an AP interface.
1423 *
1424 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1425 * @beacon: beacon data
1426 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1427 * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1428 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1429 *	user space)
1430 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1431 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1432 * @crypto: crypto settings
1433 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1434 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1435 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1436 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1437 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1438 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1439 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1440 *	MAC address based access control
1441 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1442 *	networks.
1443 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1444 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1445 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1446 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1447 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1448 * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1449 * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1450 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1451 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1452 * @he_required: stations must support HE
1453 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1454 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags
1455 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
 
1456 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1457 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1458 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1459 * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1460 * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents
1461 *	a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel.
1462 *	Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured.
1463 */
1464struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1465	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1466
1467	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1468
1469	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1470	const u8 *ssid;
1471	size_t ssid_len;
1472	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1473	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1474	bool privacy;
1475	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1476	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1477	int inactivity_timeout;
1478	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1479	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1480	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1481	bool pbss;
1482	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1483
1484	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1485	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1486	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1487	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1488	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1489	const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1490	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1491	bool twt_responder;
1492	u32 flags;
1493	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1494	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1495	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1496	struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1497	u16 punct_bitmap;
1498};
1499
1500
1501/**
1502 * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update
1503 *
1504 * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP.
1505 *
1506 * @beacon: beacon data
1507 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1508 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1509 */
1510struct cfg80211_ap_update {
1511	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1512	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1513	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1514};
1515
1516/**
1517 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1518 *
1519 * Used for channel switch
1520 *
1521 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1522 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1523 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1524 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1525 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1526 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1527 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1528 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1529 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1530 * @count: number of beacons until switch
1531 * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents
1532 *	a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel.
1533 *	Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured.
1534 */
1535struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1536	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1537	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1538	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1539	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1540	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1541	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1542	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1543	bool radar_required;
1544	bool block_tx;
1545	u8 count;
1546	u16 punct_bitmap;
1547};
1548
1549/**
1550 * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1551 *
1552 * Used for bss color change
1553 *
1554 * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1555 * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1556 * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1557 * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1558 * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1559 * @color: the color used after the change
1560 */
1561struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1562	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1563	u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1564	u16 counter_offset_presp;
1565	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1566	u8 count;
1567	u8 color;
1568};
1569
1570/**
1571 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1572 *
1573 * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1574 *
1575 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1576 *	to use for verification
1577 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1578 *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1579 *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1580 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1581 *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1582 *	nl80211_iftype.
1583 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1584 *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1585 *	the verification
1586 */
1587struct iface_combination_params {
1588	int num_different_channels;
1589	u8 radar_detect;
1590	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1591	u32 new_beacon_int;
1592};
1593
1594/**
1595 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1596 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1597 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1598 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1599 *
1600 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1601 * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1602 */
1603enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1604	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1605	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1606	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
 
1607};
1608
1609/**
1610 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1611 *
1612 * Used to configure txpower for station.
1613 *
1614 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1615 *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1616 *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1617 *	power per-interface or per-station.
1618 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1619 *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1620 *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1621 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1622 *	per peer TPC.
1623 */
1624struct sta_txpwr {
1625	s16 power;
1626	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1627};
1628
1629/**
1630 * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1631 *
1632 * Used to change and create a new link station.
1633 *
1634 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1635 * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1636 * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1637 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1638 *	(or NULL for no change)
1639 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1640 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1641 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1642 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1643 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1644 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1645 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1646 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1647 * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1648 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1649 * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1650 * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1651 */
1652struct link_station_parameters {
1653	const u8 *mld_mac;
1654	int link_id;
1655	const u8 *link_mac;
1656	const u8 *supported_rates;
1657	u8 supported_rates_len;
1658	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1659	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1660	u8 opmode_notif;
1661	bool opmode_notif_used;
1662	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1663	u8 he_capa_len;
1664	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1665	bool txpwr_set;
1666	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1667	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1668	u8 eht_capa_len;
1669};
1670
1671/**
1672 * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1673 *
1674 * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1675 *
1676 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1677 * @link_id: the link id
1678 */
1679struct link_station_del_parameters {
1680	const u8 *mld_mac;
1681	u32 link_id;
1682};
1683
1684/**
1685 * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters
1686 *
1687 * Used for setting a TID to link mapping.
1688 *
1689 * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1690 *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1691 * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1692 *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1693 */
1694struct cfg80211_ttlm_params {
1695	u16 dlink[8];
1696	u16 ulink[8];
1697};
1698
1699/**
1700 * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1701 *
1702 * Used to change and create a new station.
1703 *
1704 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1705 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1706 *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1707 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1708 *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1709 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1710 * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1711 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1712 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1713 * @plink_action: plink action to take
1714 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
 
 
1715 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1716 *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1717 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1718 *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1719 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1720 *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1721 *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1722 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1723 *	to unknown)
1724 * @capability: station capability
1725 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1726 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1727 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1728 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1729 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1730 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
 
 
1731 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
 
 
1732 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1733 * @link_sta_params: link related params.
 
1734 */
1735struct station_parameters {
 
1736	struct net_device *vlan;
1737	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1738	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1739	int listen_interval;
1740	u16 aid;
1741	u16 vlan_id;
1742	u16 peer_aid;
 
1743	u8 plink_action;
1744	u8 plink_state;
 
 
1745	u8 uapsd_queues;
1746	u8 max_sp;
1747	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1748	u16 capability;
1749	const u8 *ext_capab;
1750	u8 ext_capab_len;
1751	const u8 *supported_channels;
1752	u8 supported_channels_len;
1753	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1754	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
 
 
1755	int support_p2p_ps;
 
 
1756	u16 airtime_weight;
1757	struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
 
1758};
1759
1760/**
1761 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1762 *
1763 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1764 *
1765 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1766 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1767 *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1768 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1769 */
1770struct station_del_parameters {
1771	const u8 *mac;
1772	u8 subtype;
1773	u16 reason_code;
1774};
1775
1776/**
1777 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1778 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1779 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1780 *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1781 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1782 *	the AP MLME in the device
1783 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1784 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1785 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1786 *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1787 *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1788 *	supported/used)
1789 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1790 *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1791 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1792 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1793 */
1794enum cfg80211_station_type {
1795	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1796	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1797	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1798	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1799	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1800	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1801	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1802	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1803	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1804};
1805
1806/**
1807 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1808 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1809 * @params: the new parameters for a station
1810 * @statype: the type of station being modified
1811 *
1812 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1813 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1814 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1815 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1816 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1817 */
1818int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1819				  struct station_parameters *params,
1820				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1821
1822/**
1823 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1824 *
1825 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1826 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1827 *
1828 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1829 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1830 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1831 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1832 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1833 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1834 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1835 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1836 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS
1837 */
1838enum rate_info_flags {
1839	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1840	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1841	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1842	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1843	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1844	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1845	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
1846	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS			= BIT(7),
1847	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS			= BIT(8),
1848};
1849
1850/**
1851 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1852 *
1853 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1854 *
1855 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1856 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1857 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1858 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1859 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1860 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1861 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1862 * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1863 * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1864 * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth
1865 * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth
1866 * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth
1867 * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth
1868 * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth
1869 */
1870enum rate_info_bw {
1871	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1872	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1873	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1874	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1875	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1876	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1877	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1878	RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1879	RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1880	RATE_INFO_BW_1,
1881	RATE_INFO_BW_2,
1882	RATE_INFO_BW_4,
1883	RATE_INFO_BW_8,
1884	RATE_INFO_BW_16,
1885};
1886
1887/**
1888 * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1889 *
1890 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1891 *
1892 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
 
1893 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1894 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate
1895 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1896 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1897 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1898 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1899 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1900 *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1901 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1902 * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1903 * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1904 *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1905 */
1906struct rate_info {
1907	u16 flags;
 
1908	u16 legacy;
1909	u8 mcs;
1910	u8 nss;
1911	u8 bw;
1912	u8 he_gi;
1913	u8 he_dcm;
1914	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1915	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1916	u8 eht_gi;
1917	u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1918};
1919
1920/**
1921 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1922 *
1923 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1924 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1925 *
1926 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1927 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1928 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1929 */
1930enum bss_param_flags {
1931	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1932	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1933	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1934};
1935
1936/**
1937 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1938 *
1939 * Information about the currently associated BSS
1940 *
1941 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1942 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1943 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1944 */
1945struct sta_bss_parameters {
1946	u8 flags;
1947	u8 dtim_period;
1948	u16 beacon_interval;
1949};
1950
1951/**
1952 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1953 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1954 *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1955 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1956 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1957 * @flows: number of new flows seen
1958 * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1959 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1960 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1961 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1962 * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1963 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1964 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1965 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1966 */
1967struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1968	u32 filled;
1969	u32 backlog_bytes;
1970	u32 backlog_packets;
1971	u32 flows;
1972	u32 drops;
1973	u32 ecn_marks;
1974	u32 overlimit;
1975	u32 overmemory;
1976	u32 collisions;
1977	u32 tx_bytes;
1978	u32 tx_packets;
1979	u32 max_flows;
1980};
1981
1982/**
1983 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1984 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1985 *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1986 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1987 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1988 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1989 *	transmitted MSDUs
1990 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1991 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1992 */
1993struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1994	u32 filled;
1995	u64 rx_msdu;
1996	u64 tx_msdu;
1997	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1998	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1999	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
2000};
2001
2002#define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
2003
2004/**
2005 * struct station_info - station information
2006 *
2007 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
2008 *
2009 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
2010 *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
2011 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
2012 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
2013 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
2014 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
2015 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
2016 * @llid: mesh local link id
2017 * @plid: mesh peer link id
2018 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
2019 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2020 *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2021 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2022 *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2023 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
2024 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
2025 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
2026 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
2027 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
2028 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
2029 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
2030 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
2031 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
2032 * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
2033 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
2034 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2035 *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
2036 *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2037 *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2038 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
2039 *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
2040 *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
2041 *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
2042 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
2043 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
2044 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
2045 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
2046 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
2047 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
2048 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
2049 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
2050 *	towards this station.
2051 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
2052 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
2053 *	from this peer
2054 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
2055 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
2056 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
2057 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
2058 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
2059 *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
2060 *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
2061 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
2062 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
2063 *	been sent.
2064 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
2065 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
2066 *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
2067 *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
2068 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
2069 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
2070 * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
2071 *	by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
2072 *	MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
2073 *	information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2074 *	dump_station() callbacks.
2075 * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
2076 *	completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
2077 *	and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
2078 * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
2079 *	For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
2080 * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
2081 *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
2082 *	space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
2083 *	cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
2084 *	fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2085 *	dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
2086 *	the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
2087 * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
2088 */
2089struct station_info {
2090	u64 filled;
2091	u32 connected_time;
2092	u32 inactive_time;
2093	u64 assoc_at;
2094	u64 rx_bytes;
2095	u64 tx_bytes;
2096	u16 llid;
2097	u16 plid;
2098	u8 plink_state;
2099	s8 signal;
2100	s8 signal_avg;
2101
2102	u8 chains;
2103	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2104	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2105
2106	struct rate_info txrate;
2107	struct rate_info rxrate;
2108	u32 rx_packets;
2109	u32 tx_packets;
2110	u32 tx_retries;
2111	u32 tx_failed;
2112	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
2113	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
2114	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
2115
2116	int generation;
2117
2118	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
2119	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
2120
2121	u32 beacon_loss_count;
2122	s64 t_offset;
2123	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
2124	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
2125	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
2126
2127	u32 expected_throughput;
2128
2129	u64 tx_duration;
2130	u64 rx_duration;
2131	u64 rx_beacon;
2132	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
2133	u8 connected_to_gate;
2134
2135	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
2136	s8 ack_signal;
2137	s8 avg_ack_signal;
2138
2139	u16 airtime_weight;
2140
2141	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
2142	u32 fcs_err_count;
2143
2144	u32 airtime_link_metric;
2145
2146	u8 connected_to_as;
2147
2148	bool mlo_params_valid;
2149	u8 assoc_link_id;
2150	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2151	const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
2152	size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
2153};
2154
2155/**
2156 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
2157 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
2158 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
2159 */
2160struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2161	s32 power;
2162	u32 freq_range_index;
2163};
2164
2165/**
2166 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2167 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2168 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2169 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2170 */
2171struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2172	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2173	u32 num_sub_specs;
2174	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[];
2175};
2176
2177
2178/**
2179 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2180 * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
2181 * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
2182 */
2183struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2184	u32 start_freq;
2185	u32 end_freq;
2186};
2187
2188/**
2189 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2190 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2191 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2192 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2193 *
2194 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2195 * range to small ones and then append them.
2196 */
2197struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2198	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2199	u32 num_freq_ranges;
2200	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2201};
2202
2203#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2204/**
2205 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2206 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2207 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2208 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2209 *
2210 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2211 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2212 * considered undefined.
2213 */
2214int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2215			 struct station_info *sinfo);
2216#else
2217static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2218				       const u8 *mac_addr,
2219				       struct station_info *sinfo)
2220{
2221	return -ENOENT;
2222}
2223#endif
2224
2225/**
2226 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2227 *
2228 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2229 * according to the nl80211 flags.
2230 *
2231 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2232 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2233 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2234 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2235 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2236 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2237 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2238 */
2239enum monitor_flags {
2240	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
2241	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
2242	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
2243	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
2244	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
2245	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
2246	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
2247};
2248
2249/**
2250 * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
2251 *
2252 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2253 * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2254 *
2255 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2256 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2257 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2258 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2259 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2260 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2261 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2262 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2263 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2264 */
2265enum mpath_info_flags {
2266	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
2267	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
2268	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
2269	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
2270	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
2271	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
2272	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
2273	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
2274	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
2275};
2276
2277/**
2278 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2279 *
2280 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2281 *
2282 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2283 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2284 * @sn: target sequence number
2285 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2286 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2287 * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags
2288 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2289 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2290 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2291 *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2292 *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2293 *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2294 * @hop_count: hops to destination
2295 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2296 */
2297struct mpath_info {
2298	u32 filled;
2299	u32 frame_qlen;
2300	u32 sn;
2301	u32 metric;
2302	u32 exptime;
2303	u32 discovery_timeout;
2304	u8 discovery_retries;
2305	u8 flags;
2306	u8 hop_count;
2307	u32 path_change_count;
2308
2309	int generation;
2310};
2311
2312/**
2313 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2314 *
2315 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2316 *
2317 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2318 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2319 *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2320 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2321 *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2322 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2323 *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2324 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2325 *	(or NULL for no change)
2326 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2327 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2328 *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2329 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2330 *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2331 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2332 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2333 */
2334struct bss_parameters {
2335	int link_id;
2336	int use_cts_prot;
2337	int use_short_preamble;
2338	int use_short_slot_time;
2339	const u8 *basic_rates;
2340	u8 basic_rates_len;
2341	int ap_isolate;
2342	int ht_opmode;
2343	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2344};
2345
2346/**
2347 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2348 *
2349 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2350 *
2351 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2352 *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
2353 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2354 *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2355 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2356 *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2357 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2358 *	mesh interface
2359 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2360 *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2361 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2362 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2363 *	elements
2364 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2365 *	detect compatible mesh peers
2366 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2367 *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2368 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2369 *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2370 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2371 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2372 *	a path discovery in milliseconds
2373 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2374 *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2375 *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2376 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2377 *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2378 *	element
2379 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2380 *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2381 *	element
2382 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2383 *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2384 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2385 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2386 *	announcements are transmitted
2387 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2388 *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2389 *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2390 *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2391 *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2392 *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2393 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2394 *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2395 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2396 *	station to establish a peer link
2397 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2398 *
2399 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2400 *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2401 *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
2402 *
2403 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2404 *	PREQs are transmitted.
2405 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2406 *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2407 *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2408 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2409 *	setting for new peer links.
2410 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2411 *	after transmitting its beacon.
2412 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2413 *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2414 *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
2415 * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2416 *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2417 *	in the mesh formation field.
2418 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2419 *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2420 *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2421 *      in the mesh path table
2422 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2423 *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2424 *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2425 *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2426 *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2427 */
2428struct mesh_config {
2429	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2430	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2431	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2432	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2433	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2434	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2435	u8 element_ttl;
2436	bool auto_open_plinks;
2437	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2438	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2439	u32 path_refresh_time;
2440	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2441	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2442	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2443	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2444	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2445	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2446	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2447	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2448	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2449	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2450	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2451	s32 rssi_threshold;
2452	u16 ht_opmode;
2453	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2454	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2455	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2456	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2457	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2458	u32 plink_timeout;
2459	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2460};
2461
2462/**
2463 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2464 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2465 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2466 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2467 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2468 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2469 * @path_metric: which metric to use
2470 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2471 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2472 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2473 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2474 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2475 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2476 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2477 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2478 * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2479 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2480 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2481 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2482 *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2483 *	to operate on DFS channels.
2484 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2485 *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2486 *
2487 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2488 */
2489struct mesh_setup {
2490	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2491	const u8 *mesh_id;
2492	u8 mesh_id_len;
2493	u8 sync_method;
2494	u8 path_sel_proto;
2495	u8 path_metric;
2496	u8 auth_id;
2497	const u8 *ie;
2498	u8 ie_len;
2499	bool is_authenticated;
2500	bool is_secure;
2501	bool user_mpm;
2502	u8 dtim_period;
2503	u16 beacon_interval;
2504	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2505	u32 basic_rates;
2506	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2507	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2508	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2509};
2510
2511/**
2512 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2513 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2514 *
2515 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2516 */
2517struct ocb_setup {
2518	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2519};
2520
2521/**
2522 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2523 * @ac: AC identifier
2524 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2525 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2526 *	1..32767]
2527 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2528 *	1..32767]
2529 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2530 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2531 */
2532struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2533	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2534	u16 txop;
2535	u16 cwmin;
2536	u16 cwmax;
2537	u8 aifs;
2538	int link_id;
2539};
2540
2541/**
2542 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2543 *
2544 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2545 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2546 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2547 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2548 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2549 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2550 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2551 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2552 * in the wiphy structure.
2553 *
2554 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2555 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2556 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2557 *
2558 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2559 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2560 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2561 * to userspace.
2562 */
2563
2564/**
2565 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2566 * @ssid: the SSID
2567 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2568 */
2569struct cfg80211_ssid {
2570	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2571	u8 ssid_len;
2572};
2573
2574/**
2575 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2576 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2577 *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2578 *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2579 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2580 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2581 *	userspace will be notified of that
2582 */
2583struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2584	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2585	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2586	bool aborted;
2587};
2588
2589/**
2590 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2591 *
2592 * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2593 * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2594 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2595 *	 which the above info is relevant to
2596 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2597 * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2598 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2599 *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2600 * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value.
2601 */
2602struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2603	u32 short_ssid;
2604	u32 channel_idx;
2605	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2606	bool unsolicited_probe;
2607	bool short_ssid_valid;
2608	bool psc_no_listen;
2609	s8 psd_20;
2610};
2611
2612/**
2613 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2614 *
2615 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2616 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2617 * @channels: channels to scan on.
2618 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
 
2619 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2620 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2621 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2622 *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2623 *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2624 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2625 *	%duration field.
2626 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2627 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2628 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2629 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2630 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2631 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2632 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2633 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2634 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2635 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2636 *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2637 *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2638 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2639 *	true if this is the second scan request
2640 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2641 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2642 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2643 * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be
2644 *      used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference.
2645 */
2646struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2647	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2648	int n_ssids;
2649	u32 n_channels;
 
2650	const u8 *ie;
2651	size_t ie_len;
2652	u16 duration;
2653	bool duration_mandatory;
2654	u32 flags;
2655
2656	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2657
2658	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2659
2660	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2661	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2662	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2663
2664	/* internal */
2665	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2666	unsigned long scan_start;
2667	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2668	bool notified;
2669	bool no_cck;
2670	bool scan_6ghz;
2671	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2672	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2673	s8 tsf_report_link_id;
2674
2675	/* keep last */
2676	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2677};
2678
2679static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2680{
2681	int i;
2682
2683	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2684	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2685		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2686		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2687	}
2688}
2689
2690/**
2691 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2692 *
2693 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2694 *	or no match (RSSI only)
2695 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2696 *	or no match (RSSI only)
2697 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2698 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2699 *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertise this support
2700 *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2701 *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2702 *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2703 *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2704 *	corresponding matchset.
2705 */
2706struct cfg80211_match_set {
2707	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2708	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2709	s32 rssi_thold;
2710	s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2711};
2712
2713/**
2714 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2715 *
2716 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2717 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2718 *	infinite loop.
2719 *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2720 *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2721 */
2722struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2723	u32 interval;
2724	u32 iterations;
2725};
2726
2727/**
2728 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2729 *
2730 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2731 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2732 */
2733struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2734	enum nl80211_band band;
2735	s8 delta;
2736};
2737
2738/**
2739 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2740 *
2741 * @reqid: identifies this request.
2742 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2743 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2744 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
 
2745 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2746 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2747 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2748 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2749 *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2750 *	(others are filtered out).
2751 *	If omitted, all results are passed.
2752 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2753 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2754 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2755 * @dev: the interface
2756 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2757 * @channels: channels to scan
2758 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2759 *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2760 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2761 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2762 *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2763 *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2764 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2765 *	index must be executed first.
2766 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2767 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2768 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2769 *	owned by a particular socket)
2770 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2771 * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2772 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2773 *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2774 *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2775 *	supported.
2776 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2777 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2778 *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2779 *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2780 *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2781 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2782 *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2783 *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2784 *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2785 *	comparisons.
2786 */
2787struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2788	u64 reqid;
2789	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2790	int n_ssids;
2791	u32 n_channels;
 
2792	const u8 *ie;
2793	size_t ie_len;
2794	u32 flags;
2795	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2796	int n_match_sets;
2797	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2798	u32 delay;
2799	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2800	int n_scan_plans;
2801
2802	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2803	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2804
2805	bool relative_rssi_set;
2806	s8 relative_rssi;
2807	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2808
2809	/* internal */
2810	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2811	struct net_device *dev;
2812	unsigned long scan_start;
2813	bool report_results;
2814	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2815	u32 owner_nlportid;
2816	bool nl_owner_dead;
2817	struct list_head list;
2818
2819	/* keep last */
2820	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2821};
2822
2823/**
2824 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2825 *
2826 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2827 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2828 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2829 */
2830enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2831	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2832	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2833	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2834};
2835
2836/**
2837 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2838 * @chan: channel the frame was received on
 
2839 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2840 *	signal type
2841 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2842 *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2843 *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2844 *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2845 *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2846 *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2847 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2848 *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2849 *	by %parent_bssid.
2850 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2851 *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2852 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2853 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2854 * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is
2855 *	%NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
2856 * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2857 *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2858 * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2859 *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2860 *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2861 * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss
2862 */
2863struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2864	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
 
2865	s32 signal;
2866	u64 boottime_ns;
2867	u64 parent_tsf;
2868	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2869	u8 chains;
2870	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2871
2872	u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7;
2873	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2874
2875	void *drv_data;
2876};
2877
2878/**
2879 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2880 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2881 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2882 * @len: length of the IEs
2883 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2884 * @data: IE data
2885 */
2886struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2887	u64 tsf;
2888	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2889	int len;
2890	bool from_beacon;
2891	u8 data[];
2892};
2893
2894/**
2895 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2896 *
2897 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2898 * for use in scan results and similar.
2899 *
2900 * @channel: channel this BSS is on
 
2901 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2902 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2903 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2904 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2905 *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2906 *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2907 *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2908 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2909 *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2910 *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2911 *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2912 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2913 * @proberesp_ecsa_stuck: ECSA element is stuck in the Probe Response frame,
2914 *	cannot rely on it having valid data
2915 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2916 *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2917 *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2918 *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2919 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2920 *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2921 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2922 *	(multi-BSSID support)
2923 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2924 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2925 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2926 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2927 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2928 * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2929 *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2930 * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2931 *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2932 *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2933 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2934 */
2935struct cfg80211_bss {
2936	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
 
2937
2938	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2939	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2940	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2941
2942	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2943	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2944	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2945
2946	s32 signal;
2947
2948	u16 beacon_interval;
2949	u16 capability;
2950
2951	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2952	u8 chains;
2953	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2954
2955	u8 proberesp_ecsa_stuck:1;
2956
2957	u8 bssid_index;
2958	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2959
2960	u8 use_for;
2961	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2962
2963	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2964};
2965
2966/**
2967 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2968 * @bss: the bss to search
2969 * @id: the element ID
2970 *
2971 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2972 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2973 * Return: %NULL if not found.
2974 */
2975const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2976
2977/**
2978 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2979 * @bss: the bss to search
2980 * @id: the element ID
2981 *
2982 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2983 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2984 * Return: %NULL if not found.
2985 */
2986static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2987{
2988	return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2989}
2990
2991
2992/**
2993 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2994 *
2995 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2996 * authentication.
2997 *
2998 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2999 *	to it if it needs to keep it.
3000 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3001 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
3002 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3003 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3004 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3005 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3006 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
3007 *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
3008 *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
3009 *	transaction sequence number field.
3010 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
3011 * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
3012 *	the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
3013 *	necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
3014 *	given an MLD address) by the driver
3015 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
3016 *	an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
3017 */
3018struct cfg80211_auth_request {
3019	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3020	const u8 *ie;
3021	size_t ie_len;
3022	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3023	const u8 *key;
3024	u8 key_len;
3025	s8 key_idx;
3026	const u8 *auth_data;
3027	size_t auth_data_len;
3028	s8 link_id;
3029	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3030};
3031
3032/**
3033 * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
3034 * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
3035 *	if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
3036 * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
3037 * @elems_len: length of the elements
3038 * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it
3039 *	should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD.
3040 * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the
3041 *	operation as a whole must fail.
3042 */
3043struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
3044	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3045	const u8 *elems;
3046	size_t elems_len;
3047	bool disabled;
3048	int error;
3049};
3050
3051/**
3052 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
3053 *
3054 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
3055 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
3056 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
3057 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
3058 *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
3059 *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
3060 *	request (connect callback).
3061 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
3062 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT:  Disable EHT
3063 * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
3064 *	Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
3065 *	flag is not set.
3066 */
3067enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
3068	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
3069	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
3070	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
3071	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
3072	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
3073	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT			= BIT(5),
3074	CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT			= BIT(6),
3075};
3076
3077/**
3078 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
3079 *
3080 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3081 * (re)association.
3082 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
3083 *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
3084 *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
3085 *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
3086 *	This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
3087 *	of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
3088 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
3089 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3090 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
3091 * @crypto: crypto settings
3092 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3093 *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3094 *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3095 *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3096 *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3097 *	frame.
3098 * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3099 * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3100 *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3101 * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3102 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
3103 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
3104 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
3105 *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
3106 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
3107 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
3108 *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
3109 *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
3110 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
3111 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
3112 * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
3113 * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
3114 *	the link on which the association request should be sent
3115 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
3116 *	valid iff @link_id >= 0
3117 */
3118struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
3119	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3120	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
3121	size_t ie_len;
3122	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3123	bool use_mfp;
3124	u32 flags;
3125	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3126	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3127	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
3128	const u8 *fils_kek;
3129	size_t fils_kek_len;
3130	const u8 *fils_nonces;
3131	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
3132	struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3133	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3134	s8 link_id;
3135};
3136
3137/**
3138 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
3139 *
3140 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3141 * deauthentication.
3142 *
3143 * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
3144 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
3145 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3146 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
3147 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
3148 *	do not set a deauth frame
3149 */
3150struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
3151	const u8 *bssid;
3152	const u8 *ie;
3153	size_t ie_len;
3154	u16 reason_code;
3155	bool local_state_change;
3156};
3157
3158/**
3159 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
3160 *
3161 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3162 * disassociation.
3163 *
3164 * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
3165 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
3166 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3167 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
3168 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
3169 *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
3170 */
3171struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
3172	const u8 *ap_addr;
3173	const u8 *ie;
3174	size_t ie_len;
3175	u16 reason_code;
3176	bool local_state_change;
3177};
3178
3179/**
3180 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3181 *
3182 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3183 * method.
3184 *
3185 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3186 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3187 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3188 *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3189 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3190 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3191 *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
3192 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3193 * @ie_len: length of that
3194 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3195 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3196 *	after joining
3197 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3198 *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3199 *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3200 *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3201 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3202 *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3203 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3204 *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3205 *	to operate on DFS channels.
3206 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3207 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3208 * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3209 *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3210 * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3211 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3212 *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3213 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3214 */
3215struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3216	const u8 *ssid;
3217	const u8 *bssid;
3218	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3219	const u8 *ie;
3220	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3221	u16 beacon_interval;
3222	u32 basic_rates;
3223	bool channel_fixed;
3224	bool privacy;
3225	bool control_port;
3226	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3227	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3228	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3229	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3230	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3231	struct key_params *wep_keys;
3232	int wep_tx_key;
3233};
3234
3235/**
3236 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3237 *
3238 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3239 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3240 * @param.band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3241 * @param.adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3242 */
3243struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3244	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3245	union {
3246		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3247		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3248	} param;
3249};
3250
3251/**
3252 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3253 *
3254 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3255 * authentication and association.
3256 *
3257 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3258 *	on scan results)
3259 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3260 *	%NULL if not specified
3261 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3262 *	results)
3263 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3264 *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3265 *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3266 *	to use.
3267 * @ssid: SSID
3268 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3269 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3270 * @ie: IEs for association request
3271 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3272 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3273 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3274 * @crypto: crypto settings
3275 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3276 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3277 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3278 * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3279 * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
3280 *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3281 * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3282 *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3283 * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3284 * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
3285 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3286 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3287 *	networks.
3288 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3289 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3290 *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3291 *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3292 *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3293 *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3294 *	frame.
3295 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3296 *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3297 *	data IE.
3298 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3299 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3300 *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3301 *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3302 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3303 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3304 *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3305 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3306 *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3307 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3308 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3309 *	offload of 4-way handshake.
3310 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3311 *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3312 *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3313 */
3314struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3315	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3316	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3317	const u8 *bssid;
3318	const u8 *bssid_hint;
3319	const u8 *ssid;
3320	size_t ssid_len;
3321	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3322	const u8 *ie;
3323	size_t ie_len;
3324	bool privacy;
3325	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3326	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3327	const u8 *key;
3328	u8 key_len, key_idx;
3329	u32 flags;
3330	int bg_scan_period;
3331	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3332	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3333	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3334	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3335	bool pbss;
3336	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3337	const u8 *prev_bssid;
3338	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3339	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3340	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3341	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3342	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3343	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3344	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3345	bool want_1x;
3346	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3347};
3348
3349/**
3350 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3351 *
3352 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3353 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3354 *
3355 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3356 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3357 *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3358 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3359 */
3360enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3361	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
3362	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
3363	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
3364};
3365
3366/**
3367 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3368 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3369 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3370 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3371 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3372 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3373 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3374 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3375 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3376 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3377 */
3378enum wiphy_params_flags {
3379	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
3380	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
3381	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
3382	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
3383	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
3384	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
3385	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
3386	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
3387	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
3388};
3389
3390#define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
3391
3392/* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3393#define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
3394#define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
3395
3396/* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3397#define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
3398
3399/**
3400 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3401 *
3402 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3403 * caching.
3404 *
3405 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3406 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3407 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3408 *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3409 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3410 *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3411 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3412 *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3413 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3414 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3415 *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3416 *	%NULL).
3417 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3418 *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3419 *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3420 *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3421 *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3422 *	used for it expires.
3423 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3424 *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3425 *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3426 *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3427 *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3428 */
3429struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3430	const u8 *bssid;
3431	const u8 *pmkid;
3432	const u8 *pmk;
3433	size_t pmk_len;
3434	const u8 *ssid;
3435	size_t ssid_len;
3436	const u8 *cache_id;
3437	u32 pmk_lifetime;
3438	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3439};
3440
3441/**
3442 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3443 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3444 *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3445 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3446 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3447 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3448 *
3449 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3450 * memory, free @mask only!
3451 */
3452struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3453	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3454	int pattern_len;
3455	int pkt_offset;
3456};
3457
3458/**
3459 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3460 *
3461 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3462 * @src: source IP address
3463 * @dst: destination IP address
3464 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3465 * @src_port: source port
3466 * @dst_port: destination port
3467 * @payload_len: data payload length
3468 * @payload: data payload buffer
3469 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3470 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3471 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3472 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3473 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3474 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3475 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3476 */
3477struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3478	struct socket *sock;
3479	__be32 src, dst;
3480	u16 src_port, dst_port;
3481	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3482	int payload_len;
3483	const u8 *payload;
3484	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3485	u32 data_interval;
3486	u32 wake_len;
3487	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3488	u32 tokens_size;
3489	/* must be last, variable member */
3490	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3491};
3492
3493/**
3494 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3495 *
3496 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3497 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3498 *	operating as normal during suspend
3499 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3500 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3501 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3502 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3503 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3504 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3505 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3506 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3507 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3508 *	NULL if not configured.
3509 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3510 */
3511struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3512	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3513	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3514	     rfkill_release;
3515	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3516	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3517	int n_patterns;
3518	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3519};
3520
3521/**
3522 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3523 *
3524 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3525 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3526 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3527 *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3528 * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3529 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3530 */
3531struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3532	int delay;
3533	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3534	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3535	int n_patterns;
3536};
3537
3538/**
3539 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3540 *
3541 * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3542 * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3543 * @n_rules: number of rules
3544 */
3545struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3546	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
3547	int n_rules;
3548};
3549
3550/**
3551 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3552 *
3553 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3554 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3555 *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3556 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3557 *	occurred (in MHz)
3558 */
3559struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3560	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3561	int n_channels;
3562	u32 channels[];
3563};
3564
3565/**
3566 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3567 *
3568 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3569 *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3570 *	match information.
3571 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3572 *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3573 */
3574struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3575	int n_matches;
3576	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3577};
3578
3579/**
3580 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3581 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3582 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3583 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3584 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3585 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3586 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3587 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3588 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3589 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3590 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3591 * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3592 *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3593 *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3594 *	it is.
3595 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3596 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3597 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3598 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3599 */
3600struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3601	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3602	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3603	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3604	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3605	s32 pattern_idx;
3606	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3607	const void *packet;
3608	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3609};
3610
3611/**
3612 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3613 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3614 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3615 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3616 * @kek_len: length of kek
3617 * @kck_len: length of kck
3618 * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3619 */
3620struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3621	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3622	u32 akm;
3623	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3624};
3625
3626/**
3627 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3628 *
3629 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3630 *
3631 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3632 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3633 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3634 */
3635struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3636	u16 md;
3637	const u8 *ie;
3638	size_t ie_len;
3639};
3640
3641/**
3642 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3643 *
3644 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3645 *
3646 * @chan: channel to use
3647 * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required
3648 * @wait: duration for ROC
3649 * @buf: buffer to transmit
3650 * @len: buffer length
3651 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3652 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3653 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3654 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3655 * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3656 *	that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3657 *	link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3658 */
3659struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3660	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3661	bool offchan;
3662	unsigned int wait;
3663	const u8 *buf;
3664	size_t len;
3665	bool no_cck;
3666	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3667	int n_csa_offsets;
3668	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3669	int link_id;
3670};
3671
3672/**
3673 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3674 *
3675 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3676 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3677 */
3678struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3679	u8 dscp;
3680	u8 up;
3681};
3682
3683/**
3684 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3685 *
3686 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3687 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3688 */
3689struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3690	u8 low;
3691	u8 high;
3692};
3693
3694/* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3695#define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3696#define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3697#define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3698	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3699
3700/**
3701 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3702 *
3703 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3704 *
3705 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3706 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3707 *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3708 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3709 */
3710struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3711	u8 num_des;
3712	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3713	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3714};
3715
3716/**
3717 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3718 *
3719 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3720 *
3721 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3722 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3723 *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3724 *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3725 */
3726struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3727	u8 master_pref;
3728	u8 bands;
3729};
3730
3731/**
3732 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3733 * configuration
3734 *
3735 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3736 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3737 */
3738enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3739	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3740	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3741};
3742
3743/**
3744 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3745 *
3746 * @filter: the content of the filter
3747 * @len: the length of the filter
3748 */
3749struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3750	const u8 *filter;
3751	u8 len;
3752};
3753
3754/**
3755 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3756 *
3757 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3758 * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3759 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3760 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3761 *	implementation specific.
3762 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3763 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3764 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3765 * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up
3766 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3767 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3768 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3769 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3770 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3771 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3772 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3773 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3774 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3775 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3776 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3777 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3778 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3779 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3780 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3781 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3782 */
3783struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3784	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3785	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3786	u8 publish_type;
3787	bool close_range;
3788	bool publish_bcast;
3789	bool subscribe_active;
3790	u8 followup_id;
3791	u8 followup_reqid;
3792	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3793	u32 ttl;
3794	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3795	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3796	bool srf_include;
3797	const u8 *srf_bf;
3798	u8 srf_bf_len;
3799	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3800	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3801	int srf_num_macs;
3802	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3803	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3804	u8 num_tx_filters;
3805	u8 num_rx_filters;
3806	u8 instance_id;
3807	u64 cookie;
3808};
3809
3810/**
3811 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3812 *
3813 * @aa: authenticator address
3814 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3815 * @pmk: the PMK material
3816 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3817 *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3818 *	holds PMK-R0.
3819 */
3820struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3821	const u8 *aa;
3822	u8 pmk_len;
3823	const u8 *pmk;
3824	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3825};
3826
3827/**
3828 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3829 *
3830 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3831 *
3832 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3833 *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3834 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3835 *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3836 *	authentication response command interface.
3837 * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3838 *	authentication response command interface.
3839 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3840 *	authentication request event interface.
3841 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3842 *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3843 *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3844 *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3845 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3846 * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3847 *	interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3848 *	offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3849 *	flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3850 *	supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3851 *	User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3852 *	authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3853 *	and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3854 *	authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3855 *	translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3856 *	chosen for the authentication.
3857 */
3858struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3859	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3860	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3861	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3862	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3863	u16 status;
3864	const u8 *pmkid;
3865	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3866};
3867
3868/**
3869 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3870 *
3871 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3872 *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3873 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3874 *	answered
3875 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3876 *	successfully answered
3877 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3878 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3879 * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3880 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3881 *	of how much time the responder was busy
3882 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3883 *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3884 *	the responder
3885 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3886 *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3887 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3888 */
3889struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3890	u32 filled;
3891	u32 success_num;
3892	u32 partial_num;
3893	u32 failed_num;
3894	u32 asap_num;
3895	u32 non_asap_num;
3896	u64 total_duration_ms;
3897	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3898	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3899	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3900};
3901
3902/**
3903 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3904 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3905 *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3906 *	reason than just "failure"
3907 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3908 *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3909 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3910 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3911 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3912 *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3913 *	by the responder
3914 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3915 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3916 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3917 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3918 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3919 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3920 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3921 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3922 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3923 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3924 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3925 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3926 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3927 *	the square root of the variance)
3928 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3929 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3930 *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3931 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3932 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3933 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3934 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3935 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3936 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3937 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3938 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3939 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3940 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3941 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3942 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3943 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3944 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3945 */
3946struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3947	const u8 *lci;
3948	const u8 *civicloc;
3949	unsigned int lci_len;
3950	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3951	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3952	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3953	s16 burst_index;
3954	u8 busy_retry_time;
3955	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3956	u8 burst_duration;
3957	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3958	s32 rssi_avg;
3959	s32 rssi_spread;
3960	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3961	s64 rtt_avg;
3962	s64 rtt_variance;
3963	s64 rtt_spread;
3964	s64 dist_avg;
3965	s64 dist_variance;
3966	s64 dist_spread;
3967
3968	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3969	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3970	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3971	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3972	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3973	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3974	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3975	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3976	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
3977	    dist_avg_valid:1,
3978	    dist_variance_valid:1,
3979	    dist_spread_valid:1;
3980};
3981
3982/**
3983 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3984 * @addr: address of the peer
3985 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3986 *	measurement was made)
3987 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3988 * @status: status of the measurement
3989 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3990 *	reporting partial results always set this flag
3991 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3992 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3993 *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3994 *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
3995 * @ftm: FTM result
3996 */
3997struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3998	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3999	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
4000
4001	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4002
4003	u8 final:1,
4004	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
4005
4006	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
4007
4008	union {
4009		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
4010	};
4011};
4012
4013/**
4014 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
4015 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
4016 * @preamble: frame preamble to use
4017 * @burst_period: burst period to use
4018 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
4019 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
4020 * @burst_duration: burst duration
4021 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
4022 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
4023 * @request_lci: request LCI information
4024 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
4025 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
4026 *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4027 *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4028 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
4029 *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4030 *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4031 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
4032 *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
4033 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
4034 *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
4035 *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
4036 *
4037 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
4038 */
4039struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
4040	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
4041	u16 burst_period;
4042	u8 requested:1,
4043	   asap:1,
4044	   request_lci:1,
4045	   request_civicloc:1,
4046	   trigger_based:1,
4047	   non_trigger_based:1,
4048	   lmr_feedback:1;
4049	u8 num_bursts_exp;
4050	u8 burst_duration;
4051	u8 ftms_per_burst;
4052	u8 ftmr_retries;
4053	u8 bss_color;
4054};
4055
4056/**
4057 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
4058 * @addr: MAC address
4059 * @chandef: channel to use
4060 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
4061 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
4062 */
4063struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
4064	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4065	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4066	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
4067	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
4068};
4069
4070/**
4071 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
4072 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
4073 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
4074 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
4075 *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
4076 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
4077 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
4078 *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
4079 *	be taken from the @mac_addr
4080 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
4081 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
4082 *	zero it means there's no timeout
4083 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
4084 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
4085 */
4086struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
4087	u64 cookie;
4088	void *drv_data;
4089	u32 n_peers;
4090	u32 nl_portid;
4091
4092	u32 timeout;
4093
4094	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4095	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4096
4097	struct list_head list;
4098
4099	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers);
4100};
4101
4102/**
4103 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
4104 *
4105 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
4106 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
4107 *
4108 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
4109 *
4110 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
4111 *	has to be done.
4112 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
4113 *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
4114 *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
4115 *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
4116 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
4117 *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
4118 *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
4119 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
4120 * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
4121 *	by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
4122 *	connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
4123 *	will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4124 * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
4125 *	connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
4126 *	@assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
4127 *	with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4128 */
4129struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
4130	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4131	u16 status;
4132	const u8 *ie;
4133	size_t ie_len;
4134	int assoc_link_id;
4135	u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4136};
4137
4138/**
4139 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
4140 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4141 *	for the entire device
4142 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4143 *	for the given interface
4144 * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
4145 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
4146 *	for these subtypes
4147 */
4148struct mgmt_frame_regs {
4149	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
4150	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
4151};
4152
4153/**
4154 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
4155 *
4156 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
4157 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
4158 *
4159 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
4160 * on success or a negative error code.
4161 *
4162 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
4163 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
4164 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
4165 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
4166 *
4167 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
4168 *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4169 *	configured for the device.
4170 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4171 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4172 *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4173 *	the device.
4174 *
4175 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4176 *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4177 *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4178 *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4179 *	also set the address member in the wdev.
4180 *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4181 *
4182 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4183 *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4184 *
4185 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4186 *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4187 *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4188 *
4189 * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4190 *	the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4191 *	address is available.
4192 * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4193 *
4194 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4195 *	when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4196 *	For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4197 *	pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4198 *
4199 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4200 *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4201 *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4202 *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4203 *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4204 *	@link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4205 *	@link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4206 *	will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4207 *
4208 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4209 *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4210 *	be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4211 *	for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4212 *	address for MLO pairwise key.
4213 *
4214 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4215 *	for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4216 *
4217 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4218 *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4219 *
4220 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4221 *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4222 *
4223 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4224 *
4225 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4226 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4227 *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4228 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4229 *
4230 * @add_station: Add a new station.
4231 * @del_station: Remove a station
4232 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4233 *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4234 *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4235 *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4236 *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4237 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4238 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4239 *
4240 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4241 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4242 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4243 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4244 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4245 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4246 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4247 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4248 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4249 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4250 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4251 *
4252 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4253 *
4254 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4255 *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4256 *	set, and which to leave alone.
4257 *
4258 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4259 *
4260 * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data
4261 *	for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called
4262 *	from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock.
4263 *	The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside
4264 *	struct cfg80211_inform_bss.
4265 *	The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed.
4266 *
4267 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4268 *
4269 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4270 *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4271 *	join the mesh instead.
4272 *
4273 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4274 *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4275 *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4276 *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4277 *
4278 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4279 *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4280 *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4281 *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4282 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4283 *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4284 *
4285 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4286 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4287 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4288 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4289 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4290 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4291 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4292 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4293 *
4294 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4295 *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4296 *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4297 *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4298 *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4299 *	was received.
4300 *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4301 *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4302 *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4303 *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4304 *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
4305 *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4306 *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4307 *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4308 *	indication of requesting reassociation.
4309 *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4310 *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4311 *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4312 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4313 *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4314 *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4315 *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4316 *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4317 *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4318 *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4319 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4320 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4321 *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4322 *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
4323 *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4324 *
4325 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4326 *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4327 *	to a merge.
4328 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4329 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4330 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4331 *
4332 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4333 *	MESH mode)
4334 *
4335 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4336 *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4337 *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4338 *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4339 *
4340 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4341 *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4342 *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4343 *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4344 *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4345 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4346 *	return 0 if successful
4347 *
4348 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4349 *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4350 *
4351 * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4352 *
4353 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4354 *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4355 *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4356 *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4357 *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4358 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4359 *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4360 *	the duration value.
4361 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4362 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4363 *	frame on another channel
4364 *
4365 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4366 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4367 *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4368 *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4369 *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4370 *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4371 *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4372 *
4373 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4374 *
4375 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4376 *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4377 *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4378 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4379 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4380 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4381 *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4382 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4383 *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4384 *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4385 *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4386 *	disabled.)
4387 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4388 *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
4389 *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
4390 *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4391 *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4392 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4393 *	thresholds.
4394 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4395 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4396 *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4397 *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4398 *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4399 *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4400 *	stop (when this method returns 0).
4401 *
4402 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4403 *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4404 *
4405 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4406 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4407 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4408 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4409 *
4410 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4411 *
4412 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4413 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4414 *
4415 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4416 *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4417 *
4418 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4419 *
4420 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4421 *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4422 *	current monitoring channel.
4423 *
4424 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4425 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4426 *
4427 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4428 *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4429 *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4430 *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4431 *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4432 *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4433 *
4434 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4435 *
4436 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4437 *	was finished on another phy.
4438 *
4439 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4440 *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4441 *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4442 *
4443 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4444 *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4445 *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4446 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4447 *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
4448 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4449 *
4450 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4451 *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4452 *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4453 *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4454 *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4455 *	as soon as possible.
4456 *
4457 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4458 *
4459 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4460 *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4461 *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4462 *
4463 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4464 *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4465 *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4466 *	account.
4467 *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4468 *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4469 *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4470 *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4471 *	rejected)
4472 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4473 *
4474 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4475 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4476 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4477 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4478 *
4479 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4480 *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4481 *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4482 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4483 *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4484 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4485 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4486 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4487 *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4488 *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4489 *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4490 *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4491 *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4492 *	provided @nan_func.
4493 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4494 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4495 *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4496 *	All other parameters must be ignored.
4497 *
4498 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4499 *
4500 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4501 *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4502 *
4503 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4504 *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4505 *	upon which the driver should clear it.
4506 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4507 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4508 *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4509 *
4510 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4511 *     user space
4512 *
4513 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
4514 *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4515 *
4516 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4517 *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4518 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4519 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4520 *
4521 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4522 *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4523 *	DH IE through this interface.
4524 *
4525 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4526 *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4527 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4528 *	This callback may sleep.
4529 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4530 *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4531 *
4532 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4533 *
4534 * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4535 *
4536 * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4537 *	those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4538 *	Response frame.
4539 *
4540 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4541 *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4542 *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4543 *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4544 *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4545 *	radar channel.
4546 *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4547 *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4548 * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4549 * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4550 * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4551 *
4552 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames.
4553 * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping.
4554 */
4555struct cfg80211_ops {
4556	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4557	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4558	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4559
4560	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4561						  const char *name,
4562						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4563						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4564						  struct vif_params *params);
4565	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4566				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4567	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4568				       struct net_device *dev,
4569				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4570				       struct vif_params *params);
4571
4572	int	(*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4573				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4574				 unsigned int link_id);
4575	void	(*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4576				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4577				 unsigned int link_id);
4578
4579	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4580			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4581			   const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4582	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4583			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4584			   const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4585			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4586	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4587			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4588			   const u8 *mac_addr);
4589	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4590				   struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4591				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4592	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4593					struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4594					u8 key_index);
4595	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4596					  struct net_device *netdev,
4597					  int link_id,
4598					  u8 key_index);
4599
4600	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4601			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4602	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4603				 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info);
4604	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4605			   unsigned int link_id);
4606
4607
4608	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4609			       const u8 *mac,
4610			       struct station_parameters *params);
4611	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4612			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4613	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4614				  const u8 *mac,
4615				  struct station_parameters *params);
4616	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4617			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4618	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4619				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4620
4621	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4622			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4623	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4624			       const u8 *dst);
4625	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4626				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4627	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4628			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4629	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4630			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4631			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4632	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4633			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4634	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4635			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4636			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4637	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4638				struct net_device *dev,
4639				struct mesh_config *conf);
4640	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4641				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4642				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4643	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4644			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4645			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4646	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4647
4648	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4649			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4650	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4651
4652	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4653			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4654
4655	void	(*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
4656			      const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data);
4657
4658	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4659				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4660
4661	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4662					     struct net_device *dev,
4663					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4664
4665	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4666				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4667
4668	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4669			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4670	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4671
4672	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4673			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4674	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4675			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4676	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4677			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4678	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4679			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4680
4681	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4682			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4683	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4684					 struct net_device *dev,
4685					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4686					 u32 changed);
4687	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4688			      u16 reason_code);
4689
4690	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4691			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4692	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4693
4694	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4695				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4696
4697	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4698
4699	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4700				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4701	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4702				int *dbm);
4703
4704	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4705
4706#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4707	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4708				void *data, int len);
4709	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4710				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4711				 void *data, int len);
4712#endif
4713
4714	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4715				    struct net_device *dev,
4716				    unsigned int link_id,
4717				    const u8 *peer,
4718				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4719
4720	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4721			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4722
4723	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4724			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4725	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4726			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4727	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4728
4729	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4730				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4731				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4732				     unsigned int duration,
4733				     u64 *cookie);
4734	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4735					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4736					    u64 cookie);
4737
4738	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4739			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4740			   u64 *cookie);
4741	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4742				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4743				       u64 cookie);
4744
4745	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4746				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4747
4748	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4749				       struct net_device *dev,
4750				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4751
4752	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4753					     struct net_device *dev,
4754					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4755
4756	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4757				      struct net_device *dev,
4758				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4759
4760	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4761						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4762						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4763
4764	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4765	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4766
4767	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4768				struct net_device *dev,
4769				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4770	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4771				   u64 reqid);
4772
4773	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4774				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4775
4776	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4777			     const u8 *peer, int link_id,
4778			     u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code,
4779			     u32 peer_capability, bool initiator,
4780			     const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4781	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4782			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4783
4784	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4785				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4786
4787	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4788				  struct net_device *dev,
4789				  u16 noack_map);
4790
4791	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4792			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4793			       unsigned int link_id,
4794			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4795
4796	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4797				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4798	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4799				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4800
4801	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4802			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4803
4804	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4805					 struct net_device *dev,
4806					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4807					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4808	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4809				struct net_device *dev);
4810	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4811				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4812	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4813				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4814				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4815				    u16 duration);
4816	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4817				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4818	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4819				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4820
4821	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4822				  struct net_device *dev,
4823				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4824
4825	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4826			       struct net_device *dev,
4827			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4828
4829	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4830				    unsigned int link_id,
4831				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4832
4833	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4834			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4835			     u16 admitted_time);
4836	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4837			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4838
4839	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4840				       struct net_device *dev,
4841				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4842				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4843	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4844					      struct net_device *dev,
4845					      const u8 *addr);
4846	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4847			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4848	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4849	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4850				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4851	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4852			       u64 cookie);
4853	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4854				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4855				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4856				   u32 changes);
4857
4858	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4859					    struct net_device *dev,
4860					    const bool enabled);
4861
4862	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4863				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4864				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4865
4866	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4867			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4868	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4869			   const u8 *aa);
4870	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4871				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4872
4873	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4874				   struct net_device *dev,
4875				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4876				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4877				   const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4878				   u64 *cookie);
4879
4880	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4881				struct net_device *dev,
4882				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4883
4884	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4885			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4886	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4887			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4888	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4889				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4890	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4891				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4892	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4893				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4894	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4895				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4896	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4897				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4898	int	(*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4899				struct net_device *dev,
4900				struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4901	int     (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4902				struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4903	int	(*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4904					struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4905	int	(*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4906				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4907	int	(*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4908				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4909	int	(*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4910				    struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
4911	int	(*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4912				    struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4913	int	(*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4914			    struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params);
4915};
4916
4917/*
4918 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4919 * and registration/helper functions
4920 */
4921
4922/**
4923 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4924 *
4925 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4926 *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB.
4927 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4928 *	wiphy at all
4929 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4930 *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4931 *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4932 *	reason to override the default
4933 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4934 *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4935 *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4936 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4937 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4938 *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4939 *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4940 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4941 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4942 *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4943 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4944 *	firmware.
4945 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4946 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4947 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4948 *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4949 *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4950 *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4951 *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4952 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4953 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4954 *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4955 *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4956 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4957 *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4958 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4959 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4960 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4961 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4962 *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
 
 
4963 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4964 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
4965 *	in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
4966 *	complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
4967 *	should set this flag for now.
4968 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
4969 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for
4970 *	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER.
4971 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver
4972 *	set this flag to update channels on beacon hints.
4973 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link
4974 *	of an NSTR mobile AP MLD.
4975 */
4976enum wiphy_flags {
4977	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
4978	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO			= BIT(1),
4979	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
4980	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
4981	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
4982	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
4983	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
4984	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
4985	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
4986	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
4987	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32          = BIT(11),
4988	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= BIT(12),
4989	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
4990	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
4991	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
4992	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
4993	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
4994	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
4995	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
4996	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
4997	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
4998	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
4999	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
5000	WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER	= BIT(24),
5001	WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON     = BIT(25),
5002};
5003
5004/**
5005 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
5006 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
5007 * @types: interface types (bits)
5008 */
5009struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
5010	u16 max;
5011	u16 types;
5012};
5013
5014/**
5015 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
5016 *
5017 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
5018 * combinations it supports concurrently.
5019 *
5020 * Examples:
5021 *
5022 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
5023 *
5024 *    .. code-block:: c
5025 *
5026 *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
5027 *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5028 *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), },
5029 *	};
5030 *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
5031 *		.limits = limits1,
5032 *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
5033 *		.max_interfaces = 2,
5034 *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
5035 *	};
5036 *
5037 *
5038 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
5039 *
5040 *    .. code-block:: c
5041 *
5042 *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
5043 *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
5044 *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
5045 *	};
5046 *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
5047 *		.limits = limits2,
5048 *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
5049 *		.max_interfaces = 8,
5050 *		.num_different_channels = 1,
5051 *	};
5052 *
5053 *
5054 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
5055 *
5056 *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
5057 *
5058 *    .. code-block:: c
5059 *
5060 *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
5061 *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5062 *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
5063 *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
5064 *	};
5065 *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
5066 *		.limits = limits3,
5067 *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
5068 *		.max_interfaces = 4,
5069 *		.num_different_channels = 2,
5070 *	};
5071 *
5072 */
5073struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
5074	/**
5075	 * @limits:
5076	 * limits for the given interface types
5077	 */
5078	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
5079
5080	/**
5081	 * @num_different_channels:
5082	 * can use up to this many different channels
5083	 */
5084	u32 num_different_channels;
5085
5086	/**
5087	 * @max_interfaces:
5088	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
5089	 */
5090	u16 max_interfaces;
5091
5092	/**
5093	 * @n_limits:
5094	 * number of limitations
5095	 */
5096	u8 n_limits;
5097
5098	/**
5099	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
5100	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
5101	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
5102	 */
5103	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
5104
5105	/**
5106	 * @radar_detect_widths:
5107	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
5108	 */
5109	u8 radar_detect_widths;
5110
5111	/**
5112	 * @radar_detect_regions:
5113	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
5114	 */
5115	u8 radar_detect_regions;
5116
5117	/**
5118	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
5119	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
5120	 *
5121	 * = 0
5122	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
5123	 * > 0
5124	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
5125	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
5126	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
5127	 */
5128	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
5129};
5130
5131struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
5132	u16 tx, rx;
5133};
5134
5135/**
5136 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
5137 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
5138 *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
5139 *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
5140 *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
5141 *	packet should be preserved in that case
5142 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
5143 *	(see nl80211.h)
5144 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
5145 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
5146 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
5147 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
5148 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
5149 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
5150 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
5151 */
5152enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
5153	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
5154	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
5155	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
5156	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
5157	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
5158	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
5159	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
5160	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
5161	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
5162};
5163
5164struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
5165	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
5166	u32 data_payload_max;
5167	u32 data_interval_max;
5168	u32 wake_payload_max;
5169	bool seq;
5170};
5171
5172/**
5173 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
5174 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
5175 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
5176 *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5177 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5178 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5179 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5180 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
5181 *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
5182 *	scheduled scans.
5183 *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
5184 *	details.
5185 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
5186 */
5187struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5188	u32 flags;
5189	int n_patterns;
5190	int pattern_max_len;
5191	int pattern_min_len;
5192	int max_pkt_offset;
5193	int max_nd_match_sets;
5194	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5195};
5196
5197/**
5198 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5199 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5200 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5201 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5202 *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5203 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5204 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5205 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5206 */
5207struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5208	int n_rules;
5209	int max_delay;
5210	int n_patterns;
5211	int pattern_max_len;
5212	int pattern_min_len;
5213	int max_pkt_offset;
5214};
5215
5216/**
5217 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5218 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5219 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5220 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5221 *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5222 */
5223enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5224	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5225	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5226	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5227};
5228
5229/**
5230 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5231 *
5232 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5233 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5234 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5235 *
5236 */
5237enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5238	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
5239	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
5240	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
5241};
5242
5243/**
5244 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5245 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5246 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5247 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5248 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5249 */
5250
5251struct sta_opmode_info {
5252	u32 changed;
5253	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5254	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5255	u8 rx_nss;
5256};
5257
5258#define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5259
5260/**
5261 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5262 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5263 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5264 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5265 *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5266 *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5267 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5268 *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5269 *	dumpit calls.
5270 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5271 *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5272 *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5273 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5274 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5275 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5276 * are used with dump requests.
5277 */
5278struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5279	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5280	u32 flags;
5281	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5282		    const void *data, int data_len);
5283	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5284		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5285		      unsigned long *storage);
5286	const struct nla_policy *policy;
5287	unsigned int maxattr;
5288};
5289
5290/**
5291 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5292 * @iftype: interface type
5293 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5294 *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5295 *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5296 *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5297 *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5298 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5299 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5300 * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5301 * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5302 */
5303struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5304	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5305	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5306	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5307	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5308	u16 eml_capabilities;
5309	u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5310};
5311
5312/**
5313 * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5314 * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5315 * @type: the interface type to look up
5316 */
5317const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5318cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5319
5320/**
5321 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5322 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5323 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5324 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5325 * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5326 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5327 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5328 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5329 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5330 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5331 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5332 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5333 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5334 *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5335 *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5336 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5337 *	not limited)
5338 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5339 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5340 */
5341struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5342	unsigned int max_peers;
5343	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5344	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
5345
5346	struct {
5347		u32 preambles;
5348		u32 bandwidths;
5349		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5350		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5351		u8 supported:1,
5352		   asap:1,
5353		   non_asap:1,
5354		   request_lci:1,
5355		   request_civicloc:1,
5356		   trigger_based:1,
5357		   non_trigger_based:1;
5358	} ftm;
5359};
5360
5361/**
5362 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5363 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5364 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5365 *
5366 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5367 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5368 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5369 */
5370struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5371	u16 iftypes_mask;
5372	const u32 *akm_suites;
5373	int n_akm_suites;
5374};
5375
5376#define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS	0xffff
5377
5378/**
5379 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5380 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5381 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5382 *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5383 *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5384 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5385 *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5386 *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5387 *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5388 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5389 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5390 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5391 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5392 *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5393 *	iftype_akm_suites.
5394 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5395 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5396 *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5397 *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5398 *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5399 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5400 *	suites are specified separately.
5401 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5402 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5403 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5404 *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5405 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5406 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5407 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5408 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5409 *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5410 *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5411 *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5412 *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5413 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5414 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5415 *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5416 *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5417 *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5418 *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5419 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5420 *	unregister hardware
5421 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5422 *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5423 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5424 *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5425 *	(see below).
5426 * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5427 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5428 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5429 *	must be set by driver
5430 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5431 *	list single interface types.
5432 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5433 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5434 *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5435 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5436 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5437 *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5438 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5439 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5440 *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5441 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5442 *	this variable determines its size
5443 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5444 *	any given scan
5445 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5446 *	the device can run concurrently.
5447 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5448 *	for in any given scheduled scan
5449 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5450 *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5451 *	supported.
5452 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5453 *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5454 *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
5455 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5456 *	scans
5457 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5458 *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5459 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5460 *	single scan plan supported by the device.
5461 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5462 *	scan plan supported by the device.
5463 * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5464 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5465 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5466 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5467 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5468 *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5469 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5470 *
5471 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5472 *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5473 *	type
5474 *
5475 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5476 *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5477 *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5478 *
5479 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5480 *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5481 *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5482 *
5483 * @probe_resp_offload:
5484 *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5485 *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5486 *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5487 *
5488 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5489 *	may request, if implemented.
5490 *
5491 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5492 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5493 *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5494 *	to the suspend() operation instead.
5495 *
5496 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5497 * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5498 *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5499 * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5500 *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5501 *
5502 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5503 *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5504 *
5505 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5506 *	supports for ACL.
5507 *
5508 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5509 *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5510 *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5511 *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5512 *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5513 *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5514 *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5515 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5516 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5517 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5518 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5519 *	capabilities are specified separately.
5520 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5521 *
5522 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5523 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5524 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5525 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5526 *
5527 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5528 *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5529 *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5530 *	some cases, but may not always reach.
5531 *
5532 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5533 *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
5534 *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5535 *	infinite.
5536 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5537 *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5538 *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5539 *
5540 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5541 *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
5542 *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5543 *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5544 *
5545 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5546 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5547 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5548 *
5549 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5550 *	wake_tx_queue
5551 *
5552 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5553 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5554 *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5555 *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5556 *
5557 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5558 *
5559 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5560 *	device has
5561 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5562 *	supported by the driver for each vif
5563 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5564 *	supported by the driver for each peer
5565 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5566 *	long/short retry configuration
5567 *
5568 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5569 *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5570 *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5571 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5572 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5573 *
5574 * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5575 *	in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5576 *	by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5577 * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5578 *	the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5579 *	driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5580 * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5581 *	configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5582 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5583 *	driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5584 *	NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5585 *	legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5586 *	CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5587 *
5588 * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports
5589 *	enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a
5590 *	non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping.
5591 *	A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver
5592 *	supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to
5593 *	specify a mac address).
5594 */
5595struct wiphy {
5596	struct mutex mtx;
5597
5598	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5599
5600	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5601	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5602
5603	struct mac_address *addresses;
5604
5605	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5606
5607	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5608	int n_iface_combinations;
5609	u16 software_iftypes;
5610
5611	u16 n_addresses;
5612
5613	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5614	u16 interface_modes;
5615
5616	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5617
5618	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5619	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5620
5621	u32 ap_sme_capa;
5622
5623	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5624
5625	int bss_priv_size;
5626	u8 max_scan_ssids;
5627	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5628	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5629	u8 max_match_sets;
5630	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5631	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5632	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5633	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5634	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5635
5636	int n_cipher_suites;
5637	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5638
5639	int n_akm_suites;
5640	const u32 *akm_suites;
5641
5642	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5643	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5644
5645	u8 retry_short;
5646	u8 retry_long;
5647	u32 frag_threshold;
5648	u32 rts_threshold;
5649	u8 coverage_class;
5650
5651	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5652	u32 hw_version;
5653
5654#ifdef CONFIG_PM
5655	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5656	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5657#endif
5658
5659	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5660
5661	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5662
5663	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5664	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5665
5666	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5667
5668	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5669	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5670
5671	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5672	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5673
5674	const void *privid;
5675
5676	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5677
5678	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5679			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5680
5681	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5682
5683	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5684
5685	struct device dev;
5686
5687	bool registered;
5688
5689	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5690
5691	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5692	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5693
5694	struct list_head wdev_list;
5695
5696	possible_net_t _net;
5697
5698#ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5699	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5700#endif
5701
5702	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5703
5704	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5705	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5706	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5707
5708	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5709
5710	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5711
5712	u32 bss_select_support;
5713
5714	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5715
5716	u32 txq_limit;
5717	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5718	u32 txq_quantum;
5719
5720	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5721
5722	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5723	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5724
5725	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5726
5727	struct {
5728		u64 peer, vif;
5729		u8 max_retry;
5730	} tid_config_support;
5731
5732	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5733
5734	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5735
5736	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5737
5738	u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5739	u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5740	u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5741
5742	u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers;
5743
5744	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5745};
5746
5747static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5748{
5749	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5750}
5751
5752static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5753{
5754	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5755}
5756
5757/**
5758 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5759 *
5760 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5761 * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5762 */
5763static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5764{
5765	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5766	return &wiphy->priv;
5767}
5768
5769/**
5770 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5771 *
5772 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5773 * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5774 */
5775static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5776{
5777	BUG_ON(!priv);
5778	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5779}
5780
5781/**
5782 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5783 *
5784 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5785 * @dev: The device to parent it to
5786 */
5787static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5788{
5789	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5790}
5791
5792/**
5793 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5794 *
5795 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5796 * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5797 */
5798static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5799{
5800	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5801}
5802
5803/**
5804 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5805 *
5806 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5807 * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5808 */
5809static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5810{
5811	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5812}
5813
5814/**
5815 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5816 *
5817 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5818 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5819 * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5820 *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5821 *
5822 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5823 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5824 *
5825 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5826 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5827 */
5828struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5829			   const char *requested_name);
5830
5831/**
5832 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5833 *
5834 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5835 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5836 *
5837 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5838 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5839 *
5840 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5841 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5842 */
5843static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5844				      int sizeof_priv)
5845{
5846	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5847}
5848
5849/**
5850 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5851 *
5852 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5853 *
5854 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5855 */
5856int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5857
5858/* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5859#define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5860
5861/**
5862 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5863 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5864 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5865 *
5866 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5867 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5868 */
5869#define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
5870        rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5871
5872/**
5873 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5874 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5875 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5876 *
5877 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5878 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5879 */
5880#define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
5881        rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5882
5883/**
5884 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5885 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5886 */
5887const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5888
5889/**
5890 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5891 *
5892 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5893 *
5894 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5895 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5896 * request that is being handled.
5897 */
5898void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5899
5900/**
5901 * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5902 *
5903 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5904 */
5905void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5906
5907/* internal structs */
5908struct cfg80211_conn;
5909struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5910struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5911struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5912
5913/**
5914 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5915 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5916 *
5917 * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
5918 * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
5919 * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
5920 * differentiate which way it's called.
5921 *
5922 * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
5923 *
5924 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
5925 *
5926 * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
5927 * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
5928 */
5929static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5930	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
5931{
5932	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
5933	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
5934}
5935
5936/**
5937 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
5938 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
5939 */
5940static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5941	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
5942{
5943	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
5944	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
5945}
5946
5947struct wiphy_work;
5948typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
5949
5950struct wiphy_work {
5951	struct list_head entry;
5952	wiphy_work_func_t func;
5953};
5954
5955static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
5956				   wiphy_work_func_t func)
5957{
5958	INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
5959	work->func = func;
5960}
5961
5962/**
5963 * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
5964 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
5965 * @work: the work item
5966 *
5967 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
5968 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
5969 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
5970 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
5971 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
5972 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
5973 */
5974void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5975
5976/**
5977 * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
5978 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5979 * @work: the work to cancel
5980 *
5981 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
5982 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5983 */
5984void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5985
5986/**
5987 * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
5988 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5989 * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
5990 *
5991 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
5992 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5993 */
5994void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5995
5996struct wiphy_delayed_work {
5997	struct wiphy_work work;
5998	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5999	struct timer_list timer;
6000};
6001
6002void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
6003
6004static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6005					   wiphy_work_func_t func)
6006{
6007	timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
6008	wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
6009}
6010
6011/**
6012 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
6013 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6014 * @dwork: the delayable worker
6015 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6016 *
6017 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6018 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6019 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6020 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6021 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6022 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6023 */
6024void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6025			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6026			      unsigned long delay);
6027
6028/**
6029 * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
6030 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6031 * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
6032 *
6033 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6034 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6035 */
6036void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6037			       struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6038
6039/**
6040 * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
6041 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6042 * @dwork: the delayed work to flush
6043 *
6044 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6045 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6046 */
6047void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6048			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6049
6050/**
6051 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
6052 *
6053 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
6054 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
6055 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
6056 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
6057 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
6058 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
6059 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
6060 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
6061 *
6062 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
6063 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
6064 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
6065 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
6066 *
6067 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
6068 * @iftype: interface type
6069 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
6070 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
6071 *	for the notifier
6072 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
6073 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
6074 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
6075 *	wireless device if it has no netdev
6076 * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
6077 * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6078 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
6079 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
6080 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
6081 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
6082 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
6083 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
6084 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
6085 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
6086 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
6087 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
6088 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
6089 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
6090 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
6091 *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
6092 *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
6093 *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
6094 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
 
6095 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
6096 *	need to propagate the update to the driver
 
 
 
 
6097 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
6098 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
6099 *	the P2P Device.
6100 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
6101 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
6102 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
6103 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
6104 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
6105 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
6106 *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
6107 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
6108 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
6109 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
6110 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
6111 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
6112 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
 
 
6113 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
6114 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
6115 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
6116 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
6117 * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
6118 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
6119 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
6120 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
6121 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
6122 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
6123 *	unprotected beacon report
6124 * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
6125 *	@ap and @client for each link
6126 * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
6127 */
6128struct wireless_dev {
6129	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6130	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
6131
6132	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
6133	struct list_head list;
6134	struct net_device *netdev;
6135
6136	u32 identifier;
6137
6138	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
 
6139	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
6140
 
 
6141	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
6142
6143	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
6144
6145	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
 
 
6146	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
6147	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
6148	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
6149	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
6150
6151	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
6152	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6153
6154	struct list_head event_list;
6155	spinlock_t event_lock;
6156
6157	u8 connected:1;
 
 
 
 
 
6158
6159	bool ps;
6160	int ps_timeout;
6161
 
 
6162	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
6163
6164	u32 owner_nlportid;
6165	bool nl_owner_dead;
6166
6167	/* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */
6168	bool cac_started;
6169	unsigned long cac_start_time;
6170	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
6171
6172#ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
6173	/* wext data */
6174	struct {
6175		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
6176		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
6177		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
6178		const u8 *ie;
6179		size_t ie_len;
6180		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6181		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6182		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6183		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
6184		bool prev_bssid_valid;
6185	} wext;
6186#endif
6187
6188	struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work;
6189	struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config;
6190
6191	struct list_head pmsr_list;
6192	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6193	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6194
6195	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6196
6197	union {
6198		struct {
6199			u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6200			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6201			u8 ssid_len;
6202		} client;
6203		struct {
6204			int beacon_interval;
6205			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6206			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6207			u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6208			u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6209		} mesh;
6210		struct {
6211			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6212			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6213			u8 ssid_len;
6214		} ap;
6215		struct {
6216			struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6217			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6218			int beacon_interval;
6219			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6220			u8 ssid_len;
6221		} ibss;
6222		struct {
6223			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6224		} ocb;
6225	} u;
6226
6227	struct {
6228		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6229		union {
6230			struct {
6231				unsigned int beacon_interval;
6232				struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6233			} ap;
6234			struct {
6235				struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6236			} client;
6237		};
6238	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6239	u16 valid_links;
6240};
6241
6242static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6243{
6244	if (wdev->netdev)
6245		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6246	return wdev->address;
6247}
6248
6249static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6250{
6251	if (wdev->netdev)
6252		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6253	return wdev->is_running;
6254}
6255
6256/**
6257 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6258 *
6259 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6260 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6261 */
6262static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6263{
6264	BUG_ON(!wdev);
6265	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6266}
6267
6268/**
6269 * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6270 * @wdev: the wdev
6271 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6272 *
6273 * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6274 */
6275struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6276				       unsigned int link_id);
6277
6278static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6279					unsigned int link_id)
6280{
6281	WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6282	WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6283		!(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6284}
6285
6286#define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id)			\
6287	for (link_id = 0;					\
6288	     link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ?		\
6289			ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1);	\
6290	     link_id++)						\
6291		if (!(link_info)->valid_links ||		\
6292		    ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6293
6294/**
6295 * DOC: Utility functions
6296 *
6297 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6298 */
6299
6300/**
6301 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6302 *
6303 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6304 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6305 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6306 */
6307static inline bool
6308ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6309			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6310{
6311	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6312		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6313}
6314
6315/**
6316 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6317 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6318 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6319 */
6320static inline u32
6321ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6322{
6323	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6324}
6325
6326/**
6327 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6328 *
6329 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6330 * @chan: channel
6331 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6332 */
6333enum nl80211_chan_width
6334ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6335
6336/**
6337 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6338 * @chan: channel number
6339 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6340 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6341 */
6342u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6343
6344/**
6345 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6346 * @chan: channel number
6347 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6348 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6349 */
6350static inline int
6351ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6352{
6353	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6354}
6355
6356/**
6357 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6358 * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6359 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6360 */
6361int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6362
6363/**
6364 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6365 * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6366 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6367 */
6368static inline int
6369ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6370{
6371	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6372}
6373
6374/**
6375 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6376 * frequency
6377 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6378 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6379 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6380 */
6381struct ieee80211_channel *
6382ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6383
6384/**
6385 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6386 *
6387 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6388 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6389 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6390 */
6391static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
6392ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6393{
6394	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6395}
6396
6397/**
6398 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6399 * @chan: control channel to check
6400 *
6401 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6402 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6403 */
6404static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6405{
6406	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6407		return false;
6408
6409	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6410}
6411
6412/**
6413 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6414 *
6415 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6416 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6417 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6418 *
6419 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6420 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6421 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6422 * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6423 */
6424const struct ieee80211_rate *
6425ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6426			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6427
6428/**
6429 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6430 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
 
6431 *
6432 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
6433 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6434 */
6435u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband);
 
6436
6437/*
6438 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6439 *
6440 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6441 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6442 */
6443
6444struct radiotap_align_size {
6445	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6446};
6447
6448struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6449	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6450	int n_bits;
6451	uint32_t oui;
6452	uint8_t subns;
6453};
6454
6455struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6456	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6457	int n_ns;
6458};
6459
6460/**
6461 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6462 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6463 *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6464 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6465 *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6466 *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6467 *	the beginning of the actual data portion
6468 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6469 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6470 *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6471 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6472 *	radiotap namespace or not
6473 *
6474 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6475 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6476 * @_arg_index: next argument index
6477 * @_arg: next argument pointer
6478 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6479 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6480 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6481 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6482 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6483 *	next bitmap word
6484 *
6485 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6486 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6487 */
6488
6489struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6490	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6491	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6492	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6493
6494	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6495	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
6496
6497	unsigned char *this_arg;
6498	int this_arg_index;
6499	int this_arg_size;
6500
6501	int is_radiotap_ns;
6502
6503	int _max_length;
6504	int _arg_index;
6505	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6506	int _reset_on_ext;
6507};
6508
6509int
6510ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6511				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6512				 int max_length,
6513				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6514
6515int
6516ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6517
6518
6519extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6520extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6521
6522/**
6523 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6524 *
6525 * @skb: the frame
6526 *
6527 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6528 * returns the 802.11 header length.
6529 *
6530 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6531 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6532 * 802.11 header.
6533 */
6534unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6535
6536/**
6537 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6538 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6539 * Return: The header length in bytes.
6540 */
6541unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6542
6543/**
6544 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6545 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6546 *	(first byte) will be accessed
6547 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6548 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6549 */
6550unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6551
6552/**
6553 * DOC: Data path helpers
6554 *
6555 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6556 * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6557 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6558 */
6559
6560/**
6561 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6562 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6563 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6564 *	of it being pushed into the SKB
6565 * @addr: the device MAC address
6566 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6567 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6568 * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6569 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6570 */
6571int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6572				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6573				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6574
6575/**
6576 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6577 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6578 * @addr: the device MAC address
6579 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6580 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6581 */
6582static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6583					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6584{
6585	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6586}
6587
6588/**
6589 * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid
6590 *
6591 * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated
6592 * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the
6593 * mesh control field.
6594 *
6595 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6596 * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test
6597 *	0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field
6598 *	1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6599 *	2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6600 * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode
6601 */
6602bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr);
6603
6604/**
6605 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6606 *
6607 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6608 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6609 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6610 *
6611 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6612 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6613 *	initialized by the caller.
6614 * @addr: The device MAC address.
6615 * @iftype: The device interface type.
6616 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6617 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6618 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6619 * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu
6620 */
6621void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6622			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6623			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6624			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa,
6625			      u8 mesh_control);
6626
6627/**
6628 * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol
6629 *
6630 * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated
6631 * protocol.
6632 *
6633 * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload
6634 * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol
6635 * Return: true if encapsulation was found
6636 */
6637bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto);
6638
6639/**
6640 * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames
6641 *
6642 * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part
6643 * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh
6644 * header to the ethernet header (if present).
6645 *
6646 * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header
6647 */
6648int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb);
6649
6650/**
6651 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6652 * @skb: the data frame
6653 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6654 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6655 */
6656unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6657				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6658
6659/**
6660 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6661 *
6662 * @eid: element ID
6663 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6664 * @len: length of data
6665 * @match: byte array to match
6666 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6667 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6668 *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6669 *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6670 *	the data portion instead.
6671 *
6672 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6673 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6674 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6675 * requested element struct.
6676 *
6677 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6678 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6679 * byte array to match.
6680 */
6681const struct element *
6682cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6683			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6684			 unsigned int match_offset);
6685
6686/**
6687 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6688 *
6689 * @eid: element ID
6690 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6691 * @len: length of data
6692 * @match: byte array to match
6693 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6694 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6695 *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6696 *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6697 *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6698 *	the second byte is the IE length.
6699 *
6700 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6701 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6702 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6703 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6704 * element ID.
6705 *
6706 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6707 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6708 * byte array to match.
6709 */
6710static inline const u8 *
6711cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6712		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6713		       unsigned int match_offset)
6714{
6715	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6716	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6717	 */
6718	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6719		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
6720		return NULL;
6721
6722	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6723						      match, match_len,
6724						      match_offset ?
6725							match_offset - 2 : 0);
6726}
6727
6728/**
6729 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6730 *
6731 * @eid: element ID
6732 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6733 * @len: length of data
6734 *
6735 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6736 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6737 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6738 * requested element struct.
6739 *
6740 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6741 * having to fit into the given data.
6742 */
6743static inline const struct element *
6744cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6745{
6746	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6747}
6748
6749/**
6750 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6751 *
6752 * @eid: element ID
6753 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6754 * @len: length of data
6755 *
6756 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6757 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6758 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6759 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6760 *
6761 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6762 * having to fit into the given data.
6763 */
6764static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6765{
6766	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6767}
6768
6769/**
6770 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
6771 *
6772 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6773 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6774 * @len: length of data
6775 *
6776 * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if
6777 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6778 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6779 * requested element struct.
6780 *
6781 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6782 * having to fit into the given data.
6783 */
6784static inline const struct element *
6785cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6786{
6787	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6788					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
6789}
6790
6791/**
6792 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
6793 *
6794 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6795 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6796 * @len: length of data
6797 *
6798 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
6799 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6800 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6801 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6802 *
6803 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6804 * having to fit into the given data.
6805 */
6806static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6807{
6808	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6809				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
6810}
6811
6812/**
6813 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
6814 *
6815 * @oui: vendor OUI
6816 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6817 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6818 * @len: length of data
6819 *
6820 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6821 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
6822 * return the element structure for the requested element.
6823 *
6824 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6825 * the given data.
6826 */
6827const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6828						const u8 *ies,
6829						unsigned int len);
6830
6831/**
6832 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
6833 *
6834 * @oui: vendor OUI
6835 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6836 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6837 * @len: length of data
6838 *
6839 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6840 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6841 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6842 * element ID.
6843 *
6844 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6845 * the given data.
6846 */
6847static inline const u8 *
6848cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6849			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
6850{
6851	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
6852}
6853
6854/**
6855 * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer
6856 *
6857 * @elem: the element to defragment
6858 * @ies: elements where @elem is contained
6859 * @ieslen: length of @ies
6860 * @data: buffer to store element data
6861 * @data_len: length of @data
6862 * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments
6863 *
6864 * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error
6865 *
6866 * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while
6867 * skipping all headers.
6868 *
6869 * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an
6870 * element in-place.
6871 */
6872ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies,
6873				    size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len,
6874				    u8 frag_id);
6875
6876/**
6877 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
6878 *
6879 * @dev: network device
6880 * @addr: STA MAC address
6881 *
6882 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
6883 * devices upon STA association.
6884 */
6885void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6886
6887/**
6888 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
6889 *
6890 * TODO
6891 */
6892
6893/**
6894 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
6895 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
6896 *	conflicts)
6897 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
6898 *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
6899 *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
6900 *	alpha2.
6901 *
6902 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
6903 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
6904 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
6905 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
6906 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
6907 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
6908 *
6909 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
6910 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
6911 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
6912 *
6913 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6914 * an -ENOMEM.
6915 *
6916 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
6917 */
6918int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
6919
6920/**
6921 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
6922 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6923 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6924 *
6925 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
6926 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
6927 * information.
6928 *
6929 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6930 */
6931int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6932			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6933
6934/**
6935 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
6936 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6937 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6938 *
6939 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
6940 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
6941 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
6942 *
6943 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6944 */
6945int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6946				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6947
6948/**
6949 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
6950 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6951 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
6952 *
6953 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
6954 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
6955 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
6956 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
6957 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
6958 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
6959 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
6960 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
6961 * that called this helper.
6962 */
6963void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6964				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
6965
6966/**
6967 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
6968 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
6969 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
6970 *
6971 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
6972 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
6973 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
6974 * and processed already.
6975 *
6976 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
6977 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
6978 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
6979 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
6980 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
6981 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
6982 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
6983 */
6984const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6985					       u32 center_freq);
6986
6987/**
6988 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
6989 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
6990 *
6991 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
6992 * proper string representation.
6993 */
6994const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
6995
6996/**
6997 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
6998 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
6999 *
7000 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
7001 */
7002bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7003
7004/**
7005 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
7006 *
7007 */
7008
7009/**
7010 * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
7011 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
7012 *
7013 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
7014 * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried.
7015 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
7016 *
7017 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
7018 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
7019 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
7020 *
7021 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7022 * an -ENODATA.
7023 *
7024 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
7025 */
7026int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
7027			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
7028
7029/*
7030 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
7031 * functions and BSS handling helpers
7032 */
7033
7034/**
7035 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
7036 *
7037 * @request: the corresponding scan request
7038 * @info: information about the completed scan
7039 */
7040void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
7041			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
7042
7043/**
7044 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
7045 *
7046 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
7047 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7048 */
7049void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7050
7051/**
7052 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7053 *
7054 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7055 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7056 *
7057 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7058 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7059 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7060 */
7061void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7062
7063/**
7064 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7065 *
7066 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7067 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7068 *
7069 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7070 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7071 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7072 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
7073 */
7074void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7075
7076/**
7077 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
7078 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7079 * @data: the BSS metadata
7080 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
7081 * @len: length of the management frame
7082 * @gfp: context flags
7083 *
7084 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7085 * the BSS should be updated/added.
7086 *
7087 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7088 * Or %NULL on error.
7089 */
7090struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7091cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7092			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7093			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7094			       gfp_t gfp);
7095
7096static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7097cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7098			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7099			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7100			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7101{
7102	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7103		.chan = rx_channel,
 
7104		.signal = signal,
7105	};
7106
7107	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
7108}
7109
7110/**
7111 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
7112 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
7113 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
7114 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
7115 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
7116 */
7117static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
7118					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
7119{
7120	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
7121	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
7122	u64 new_bssid_u64;
7123
7124	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
7125
7126	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
7127
7128	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
7129}
7130
7131/**
7132 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
7133 * @element: element to check
7134 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
7135 */
7136bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
7137				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
7138
7139/**
7140 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
7141 * @ie: ies
7142 * @ielen: length of IEs
7143 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
7144 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
7145 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
7146 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
7147 */
7148size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7149			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
7150			      const struct element *sub_elem,
7151			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
7152
7153/**
7154 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
7155 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
7156 *	from a beacon or probe response
7157 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
7158 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
7159 */
7160enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
7161	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
7162	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
7163	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
7164};
7165
7166/**
7167 * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
7168 * @ie: IEs
7169 * @ielen: length of IEs
7170 * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
7171 *
7172 * Returns the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
7173 */
7174int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7175				    enum nl80211_band band);
7176
7177/**
7178 * cfg80211_ssid_eq - compare two SSIDs
7179 * @a: first SSID
7180 * @b: second SSID
7181 *
7182 * Return: %true if SSIDs are equal, %false otherwise.
7183 */
7184static inline bool
7185cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid *a, struct cfg80211_ssid *b)
7186{
7187	if (WARN_ON(!a || !b))
7188		return false;
7189	if (a->ssid_len != b->ssid_len)
7190		return false;
7191	return memcmp(a->ssid, b->ssid, a->ssid_len) ? false : true;
7192}
7193
7194/**
7195 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
7196 *
7197 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7198 * @data: the BSS metadata
7199 * @ftype: frame type (if known)
7200 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
7201 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
7202 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
7203 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
7204 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
7205 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
7206 * @gfp: context flags
7207 *
7208 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7209 * the BSS should be updated/added.
7210 *
7211 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7212 * Or %NULL on error.
7213 */
7214struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7215cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7216			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7217			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7218			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7219			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7220			 gfp_t gfp);
7221
7222static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7223cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7224		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7225		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7226		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7227		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7228		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7229{
7230	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7231		.chan = rx_channel,
 
7232		.signal = signal,
7233	};
7234
7235	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7236					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7237					gfp);
7238}
7239
7240/**
7241 * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7242 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7243 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7244 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7245 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7246 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7247 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7248 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7249 * @use_for: indicates which use is intended
7250 */
7251struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7252					struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7253					const u8 *bssid,
7254					const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7255					enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7256					enum ieee80211_privacy privacy,
7257					u32 use_for);
7258
7259/**
7260 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7261 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7262 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7263 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7264 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7265 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7266 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7267 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7268 *
7269 * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
7270 */
7271static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
7272cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7273		 const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7274		 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7275		 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)
7276{
7277	return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len,
7278				  bss_type, privacy,
7279				  NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL);
7280}
7281
7282static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
7283cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7284		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7285		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7286{
7287	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7288				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7289				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7290}
7291
7292/**
7293 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7294 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7295 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7296 *
7297 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7298 */
7299void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7300
7301/**
7302 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7303 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7304 * @bss: the BSS struct
7305 *
7306 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7307 */
7308void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7309
7310/**
7311 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7312 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7313 * @bss: the bss to remove
7314 *
7315 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7316 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7317 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7318 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7319 */
7320void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7321
7322/**
7323 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7324 *
7325 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7326 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7327 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7328 *
7329 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7330 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7331 *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7332 * @iter: the iterator function to call
7333 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7334 */
7335void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7336		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7337		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7338				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7339				    void *data),
7340		       void *iter_data);
7341
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7342/**
7343 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7344 * @dev: network device
7345 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7346 * @len: length of the frame data
7347 *
7348 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7349 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7350 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7351 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7352 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7353 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7354 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7355 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7356 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7357 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7358 *
7359 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7360 */
7361void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7362
7363/**
7364 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7365 * @dev: network device
7366 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7367 *
7368 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7369 * mutex.
7370 */
7371void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7372
7373/**
7374 * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data
 
 
 
7375 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7376 * @len: length of the frame data
7377 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7378 *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7379 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7380 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7381 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7382 * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7383 *	non-MLO connections
7384 * @links.bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the
7385 *      pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7386 * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7387 *	were rejected by the AP.
7388 */
7389struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data {
7390	const u8 *buf;
7391	size_t len;
7392	const u8 *req_ies;
7393	size_t req_ies_len;
7394	int uapsd_queues;
7395	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7396	struct {
7397		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
7398		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7399		u16 status;
7400	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7401};
7402
7403/**
7404 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7405 * @dev: network device
7406 * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data
7407 *
7408 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7409 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7410 *
7411 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7412 */
7413void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7414			    const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data);
 
 
 
7415
7416/**
7417 * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7418 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7419 * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7420 *	(@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7421 * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7422 *	the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7423 *	other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7424 */
7425struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7426	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7427	struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7428	bool timeout;
7429};
7430
7431/**
7432 * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7433 * @dev: network device
7434 * @data: data describing the association failure
7435 *
 
 
7436 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7437 */
7438void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7439			    struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7440
7441/**
7442 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7443 * @dev: network device
7444 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7445 * @len: length of the frame data
7446 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7447 *
7448 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7449 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7450 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7451 * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7452 */
7453void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7454			   bool reconnect);
7455
7456/**
7457 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7458 * @dev: network device
7459 * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7460 * @len: length of the frame data
7461 *
7462 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7463 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7464 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7465 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7466 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7467 *
7468 * This function may sleep.
7469 */
7470void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7471				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7472
7473/**
7474 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7475 * @dev: network device
7476 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7477 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7478 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7479 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7480 * @gfp: allocation flags
7481 *
7482 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7483 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7484 * primitive.
7485 */
7486void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7487				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7488				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7489
7490/**
7491 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7492 *
7493 * @dev: network device
7494 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7495 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7496 * @gfp: allocation flags
7497 *
7498 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7499 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7500 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7501 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7502 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7503 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7504 */
7505void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7506			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7507
7508/**
7509 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7510 * 					candidate
7511 *
7512 * @dev: network device
7513 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7514 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7515 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7516 * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7517 * @gfp: allocation flags
7518 *
7519 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7520 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7521 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7522 */
7523void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7524		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7525		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7526
7527/**
7528 * DOC: RFkill integration
7529 *
7530 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7531 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7532 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7533 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are
7534 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7535 *
7536 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7537 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7538 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7539 */
7540
7541/**
7542 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7543 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7544 * @blocked: block status
7545 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7546 */
7547void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7548				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7549
7550static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7551{
7552	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7553					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7554}
7555
7556/**
7557 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7558 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7559 */
7560void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7561
7562/**
7563 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7564 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7565 */
7566static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7567{
7568	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7569}
7570
7571/**
7572 * DOC: Vendor commands
7573 *
7574 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7575 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7576 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7577 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7578 * the configuration mechanism.
7579 *
7580 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7581 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an
7582 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7583 *
7584 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7585 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7586 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7587 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7588 * managers etc. need.
7589 */
7590
7591struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7592					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7593					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7594					   int approxlen);
7595
7596struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7597					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7598					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7599					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7600					   unsigned int portid,
7601					   int vendor_event_idx,
7602					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7603
7604void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7605
7606/**
7607 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7608 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7609 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7610 *	be put into the skb
7611 *
7612 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7613 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7614 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7615 *
7616 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7617 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7618 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7619 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7620 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7621 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7622 * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7623 *
7624 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7625 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7626 *
7627 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7628 */
7629static inline struct sk_buff *
7630cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7631{
7632	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7633					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7634}
7635
7636/**
7637 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7638 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7639 *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7640 *
7641 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7642 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7643 * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
7644 * skb regardless of the return value.
7645 *
7646 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7647 */
7648int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7649
7650/**
7651 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7652 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7653 *
7654 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7655 * Valid to call only there.
7656 */
7657unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7658
7659/**
7660 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7661 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7662 * @wdev: the wireless device
7663 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7664 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7665 *	be put into the skb
7666 * @gfp: allocation flags
7667 *
7668 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7669 * vendor-specific multicast group.
7670 *
7671 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7672 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7673 * attribute.
7674 *
7675 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7676 * skb to send the event.
7677 *
7678 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7679 */
7680static inline struct sk_buff *
7681cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7682			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7683{
7684	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7685					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7686					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7687}
7688
7689/**
7690 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7691 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7692 * @wdev: the wireless device
7693 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7694 * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7695 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7696 *	be put into the skb
7697 * @gfp: allocation flags
7698 *
7699 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7700 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7701 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7702 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7703 *
7704 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7705 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7706 * attribute.
7707 *
7708 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7709 * skb to send the event.
7710 *
7711 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7712 */
7713static inline struct sk_buff *
7714cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7715				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7716				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
7717				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7718{
7719	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7720					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7721					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7722}
7723
7724/**
7725 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
7726 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
7727 * @gfp: allocation flags
7728 *
7729 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7730 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
7731 */
7732static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7733{
7734	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7735}
7736
7737#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
7738/**
7739 * DOC: Test mode
7740 *
7741 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
7742 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
7743 * factory programming.
7744 *
7745 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more
7746 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
7747 */
7748
7749/**
7750 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
7751 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7752 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7753 *	be put into the skb
7754 *
7755 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7756 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7757 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
7758 *
7759 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
7760 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7761 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7762 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7763 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7764 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
7765 * must not modify the skb in any other way.
7766 *
7767 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
7768 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
7769 *
7770 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7771 */
7772static inline struct sk_buff *
7773cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7774{
7775	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7776					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
7777}
7778
7779/**
7780 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
7781 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7782 *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
7783 *
7784 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7785 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
7786 * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
7787 * regardless of the return value.
7788 *
7789 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7790 */
7791static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
7792{
7793	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
7794}
7795
7796/**
7797 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
7798 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7799 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7800 *	be put into the skb
7801 * @gfp: allocation flags
7802 *
7803 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7804 * testmode multicast group.
7805 *
7806 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
7807 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
7808 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
7809 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
7810 * in any other way.
7811 *
7812 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
7813 * skb to send the event.
7814 *
7815 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7816 */
7817static inline struct sk_buff *
7818cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
7819{
7820	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7821					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
7822					  approxlen, gfp);
7823}
7824
7825/**
7826 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
7827 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7828 *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
7829 * @gfp: allocation flags
7830 *
7831 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7832 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
7833 * consumes it.
7834 */
7835static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7836{
7837	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7838}
7839
7840#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
7841#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
7842#else
7843#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
7844#define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
7845#endif
7846
7847/**
7848 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
7849 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
7850 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
7851 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
7852 *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
7853 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
7854 *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
7855 *	status for a FILS connection.
7856 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7857 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
7858 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
7859 *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7860 */
7861struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
7862	const u8 *kek;
7863	size_t kek_len;
7864	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
7865	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
7866	const u8 *pmk;
7867	size_t pmk_len;
7868	const u8 *pmkid;
7869};
7870
7871/**
7872 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
7873 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7874 *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7875 *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7876 *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7877 *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7878 *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7879 *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7880 *	case.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7881 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
7882 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
7883 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7884 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
7885 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
7886 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7887 *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7888 *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7889 *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7890 *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7891 *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7892 * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
7893 *	zero.
7894 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
7895 * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
7896 *	using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
7897 *	connected AP info.
7898 * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
7899 *	%NULL.
7900 * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
7901 *	connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
7902 * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
7903 *	For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
7904 *	is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
7905 *	%NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
7906 *	hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
7907 *	if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
7908 *	implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
7909 *	to be specified.
7910 * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
7911 *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
7912 *	@valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
7913 */
7914struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
7915	int status;
 
 
7916	const u8 *req_ie;
7917	size_t req_ie_len;
7918	const u8 *resp_ie;
7919	size_t resp_ie_len;
7920	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7921	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
7922
7923	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7924	u16 valid_links;
7925	struct {
7926		const u8 *addr;
7927		const u8 *bssid;
7928		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7929		u16 status;
7930	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7931};
7932
7933/**
7934 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7935 *
7936 * @dev: network device
7937 * @params: connection response parameters
7938 * @gfp: allocation flags
7939 *
7940 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7941 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7942 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
7943 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
7944 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
7945 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7946 */
7947void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
7948			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
7949			   gfp_t gfp);
7950
7951/**
7952 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7953 *
7954 * @dev: network device
7955 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7956 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
7957 *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
7958 *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
7959 *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
7960 *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
7961 *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
7962 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7963 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7964 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7965 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7966 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7967 *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7968 *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7969 *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7970 *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7971 *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7972 *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7973 *	case.
7974 * @gfp: allocation flags
7975 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7976 *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7977 *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7978 *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7979 *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7980 *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7981 *
7982 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7983 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7984 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
7985 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
7986 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7987 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7988 */
7989static inline void
7990cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7991		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
7992		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
7993		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
7994		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7995{
7996	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
7997
7998	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
7999	params.status = status;
8000	params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
8001	params.links[0].bss = bss;
8002	params.req_ie = req_ie;
8003	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
8004	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
8005	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
8006	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
8007
8008	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
8009}
8010
8011/**
8012 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8013 *
8014 * @dev: network device
8015 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8016 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8017 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8018 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8019 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8020 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8021 *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8022 *	the real status code for failures.
8023 * @gfp: allocation flags
8024 *
8025 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8026 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8027 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
8028 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8029 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8030 */
8031static inline void
8032cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8033			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
8034			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
8035			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
8036{
8037	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
8038			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
8039			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
8040}
8041
8042/**
8043 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
8044 *
8045 * @dev: network device
8046 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8047 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8048 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8049 * @gfp: allocation flags
8050 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
8051 *
8052 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
8053 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
8054 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
8055 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
8056 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
8057 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8058 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8059 */
8060static inline void
8061cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8062			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
8063			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8064{
8065	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
8066			     gfp, timeout_reason);
8067}
8068
8069/**
8070 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
8071 *
 
 
 
8072 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8073 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8074 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8075 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8076 * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
8077 * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
8078 *	Otherwise zero.
8079 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8080 * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
8081 *	@valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
8082 * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
8083 * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
8084 *	roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
8085 *	%NULL if %links.bss is set.
8086 * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
8087 * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
8088 *	roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
8089 *	which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
8090 */
8091struct cfg80211_roam_info {
 
 
 
8092	const u8 *req_ie;
8093	size_t req_ie_len;
8094	const u8 *resp_ie;
8095	size_t resp_ie_len;
8096	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8097
8098	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8099	u16 valid_links;
8100	struct {
8101		const u8 *addr;
8102		const u8 *bssid;
8103		struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
8104		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8105	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8106};
8107
8108/**
8109 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
8110 *
8111 * @dev: network device
8112 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
8113 * @gfp: allocation flags
8114 *
8115 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
8116 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
8117 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
8118 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
8119 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
8120 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
8121 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
8122 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
8123 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
8124 * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
8125 */
8126void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
8127		     gfp_t gfp);
8128
8129/**
8130 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
8131 *
8132 * @dev: network device
8133 * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
8134 *	in case of AP/P2P GO
8135 * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
8136 * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
8137 * @gfp: allocation flags
8138 *
8139 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
8140 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
8141 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
8142 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
8143 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
8144 * indicate the 802.11 association.
8145 * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
8146 * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
8147 * associated STA/GC.
8148 */
8149void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
8150			      const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
8151
8152/**
8153 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
8154 *
8155 * @dev: network device
8156 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
8157 * @ie_len: length of IEs
8158 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
8159 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
8160 * @gfp: allocation flags
8161 *
8162 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
8163 * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
8164 */
8165void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
8166			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
8167			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
8168
8169/**
8170 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
8171 * @wdev: wireless device
8172 * @cookie: the request cookie
8173 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8174 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
8175 *	channel
8176 * @gfp: allocation flags
8177 */
8178void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8179			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8180			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
8181
8182/**
8183 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
8184 * @wdev: wireless device
8185 * @cookie: the request cookie
8186 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8187 * @gfp: allocation flags
8188 */
8189void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8190					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8191					gfp_t gfp);
8192
8193/**
8194 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
8195 * @wdev: wireless device
8196 * @cookie: the requested cookie
8197 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
8198 * @gfp: allocation flags
8199 */
8200void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8201			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
8202
8203/**
8204 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
8205 *
8206 * @sinfo: the station information
8207 * @gfp: allocation flags
8208 */
8209int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8210
8211/**
8212 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
8213 * @sinfo: the station information
8214 *
8215 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
8216 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
8217 * the stack.)
8218 */
8219static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
8220{
8221	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
8222}
8223
8224/**
8225 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
8226 *
8227 * @dev: the netdev
8228 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8229 * @sinfo: the station information
8230 * @gfp: allocation flags
8231 */
8232void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8233		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8234
8235/**
8236 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8237 * @dev: the netdev
8238 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8239 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8240 * @gfp: allocation flags
8241 */
8242void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8243			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8244
8245/**
8246 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8247 *
8248 * @dev: the netdev
8249 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8250 * @gfp: allocation flags
8251 */
8252static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8253				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8254{
8255	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8256}
8257
8258/**
8259 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8260 *
8261 * @dev: the netdev
8262 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8263 * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8264 * @gfp: allocation flags
8265 *
8266 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8267 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8268 * for some reasons, this function is called.
8269 *
8270 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8271 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8272 */
8273void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8274			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8275			  gfp_t gfp);
8276
8277/**
8278 * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8279 *
8280 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8281 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8282 * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8283 *	an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8284 * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received	on
8285 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8286 * @len: length of the frame data
8287 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8288 * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8289 * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8290 */
8291struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8292	int freq;
8293	int sig_dbm;
8294	bool have_link_id;
8295	u8 link_id;
8296	const u8 *buf;
8297	size_t len;
8298	u32 flags;
8299	u64 rx_tstamp;
8300	u64 ack_tstamp;
8301};
8302
8303/**
8304 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8305 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8306 * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8307 *
8308 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8309 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8310 *
8311 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8312 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8313 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8314 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8315 */
8316bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8317			  struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8318
8319/**
8320 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8321 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8322 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8323 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8324 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8325 * @len: length of the frame data
8326 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8327 *
8328 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8329 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8330 *
8331 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8332 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8333 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8334 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8335 */
8336static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8337					int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8338					u32 flags)
8339{
8340	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8341		.freq = freq,
8342		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8343		.buf = buf,
8344		.len = len,
8345		.flags = flags
8346	};
8347
8348	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8349}
8350
8351/**
8352 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8353 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8354 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8355 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8356 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8357 * @len: length of the frame data
8358 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8359 *
8360 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8361 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8362 *
8363 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8364 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8365 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8366 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8367 */
8368static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8369				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8370				    u32 flags)
8371{
8372	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8373		.freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8374		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8375		.buf = buf,
8376		.len = len,
8377		.flags = flags
8378	};
8379
8380	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8381}
8382
8383/**
8384 * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8385 *
8386 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8387 * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8388 * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8389 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8390 * @len: length of the frame data
8391 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8392 */
8393struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8394	u64 cookie;
8395	u64 tx_tstamp;
8396	u64 ack_tstamp;
8397	const u8 *buf;
8398	size_t len;
8399	bool ack;
8400};
8401
8402/**
8403 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8404 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8405 * @status: TX status data
8406 * @gfp: context flags
8407 *
8408 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8409 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8410 * transmission attempt with extended info.
8411 */
8412void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8413				 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8414
8415/**
8416 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8417 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8418 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8419 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8420 * @len: length of the frame data
8421 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8422 * @gfp: context flags
8423 *
8424 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8425 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8426 * transmission attempt.
8427 */
8428static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8429					   u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8430					   size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8431{
8432	struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8433		.cookie = cookie,
8434		.buf = buf,
8435		.len = len,
8436		.ack = ack
8437	};
8438
8439	cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8440}
8441
8442/**
8443 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8444 *                                   port frames
8445 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8446 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8447 * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8448 * @len: length of the frame data
8449 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8450 * @gfp: context flags
8451 *
8452 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8453 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8454 * the transmission attempt.
8455 */
8456void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8457				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8458				     gfp_t gfp);
8459
8460/**
8461 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8462 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8463 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
8464 *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
8465 *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8466 *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
8467 *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8468 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8469 * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8470 *
8471 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8472 * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8473 * control port frames over nl80211.
8474 *
8475 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8476 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8477 *
8478 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8479 */
8480bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8481			      bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8482
8483/**
8484 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8485 * @dev: network device
8486 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8487 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8488 * @gfp: context flags
8489 *
8490 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8491 * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8492 */
8493void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8494			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8495			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8496
8497/**
8498 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8499 * @dev: network device
8500 * @peer: peer's MAC address
8501 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8502 *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8503 *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8504 * @gfp: context flags
8505 */
8506void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8507				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8508
8509/**
8510 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8511 * @dev: network device
8512 * @peer: peer's MAC address
8513 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8514 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8515 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8516 * @gfp: context flags
8517 *
8518 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8519 * given interval is exceeded.
8520 */
8521void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8522			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8523
8524/**
8525 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8526 * @dev: network device
8527 * @gfp: context flags
8528 *
8529 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8530 */
8531void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8532
8533/**
8534 * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8535 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8536 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8537 * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8538 * @gfp: context flags
8539 *
8540 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8541 */
8542void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8543			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8544			    bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8545
8546static inline void
8547cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8548		     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8549		     gfp_t gfp)
8550{
8551	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8552}
8553
8554static inline void
8555cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8556				struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8557				gfp_t gfp)
8558{
8559	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8560}
8561
8562/**
8563 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8564 * @dev: network device
8565 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8566 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8567 * @gfp: context flags
8568 *
8569 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8570 * frame.
8571 */
8572void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8573				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8574				       gfp_t gfp);
8575
8576/**
8577 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8578 * @netdev: network device
8579 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8580 * @event: type of event
8581 * @gfp: context flags
8582 *
8583 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8584 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8585 * also by full-MAC drivers.
8586 */
8587void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8588			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8589			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
8590
8591/**
8592 * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8593 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8594 *
8595 * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8596 * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8597 */
8598void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8599
8600/**
8601 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8602 * @dev: network device
8603 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8604 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8605 * @gfp: allocation flags
8606 */
8607void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8608			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8609
8610/**
8611 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8612 * @dev: network device
8613 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8614 * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8615 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8616 * @gfp: allocation flags
8617 */
8618void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8619				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8620
8621/**
8622 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8623 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8624 * @addr: the transmitter address
8625 * @gfp: context flags
8626 *
8627 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8628 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8629 * sender.
8630 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8631 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8632 */
8633bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8634				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8635
8636/**
8637 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8638 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8639 * @addr: the transmitter address
8640 * @gfp: context flags
8641 *
8642 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8643 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8644 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8645 * station to avoid event flooding.
8646 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8647 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8648 */
8649bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8650					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8651
8652/**
8653 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8654 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8655 * @addr: the address of the peer
8656 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8657 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8658 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8659 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8660 * @gfp: allocation flags
8661 */
8662void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8663			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8664			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8665
8666/**
8667 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8668 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8669 * @frame: the frame
8670 * @len: length of the frame
8671 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8672 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8673 *
8674 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8675 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8676 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8677 */
8678void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8679				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8680
8681/**
8682 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8683 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8684 * @frame: the frame
8685 * @len: length of the frame
8686 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8687 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8688 *
8689 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8690 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8691 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8692 */
8693static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8694					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8695					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
8696{
8697	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8698					sig_dbm);
8699}
8700
8701/**
8702 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
8703 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8704 * @chandef: the channel definition
8705 * @iftype: interface type
8706 *
8707 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8708 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8709 */
8710bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8711			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8712			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8713
8714/**
8715 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
8716 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8717 * @chandef: the channel definition
8718 * @iftype: interface type
8719 *
8720 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8721 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
8722 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
8723 * more permissive conditions.
8724 *
8725 * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
8726 */
8727bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8728				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8729				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8730
8731/*
8732 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
8733 * @dev: the device which switched channels
8734 * @chandef: the new channel definition
8735 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8736 * @punct_bitmap: the new puncturing bitmap
8737 *
8738 * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable
8739 * driver context!
8740 */
8741void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8742			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8743			       unsigned int link_id, u16 punct_bitmap);
8744
8745/*
8746 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
8747 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
8748 * @chandef: the future channel definition
8749 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8750 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
8751 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
8752 * @punct_bitmap: the future puncturing bitmap
8753 *
8754 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
8755 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
8756 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
8757 */
8758void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8759				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8760				       unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
8761				       bool quiet, u16 punct_bitmap);
8762
8763/**
8764 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
8765 *
8766 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
8767 * @band: band pointer to fill
8768 *
8769 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8770 */
8771bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
8772				       enum nl80211_band *band);
8773
8774/**
8775 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
8776 *
8777 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8778 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
8779 *
8780 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8781 */
8782bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8783					  u8 *op_class);
8784
8785/**
8786 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
8787 *
8788 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8789 *
8790 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
8791 */
8792static inline u32
8793ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
8794{
8795	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
8796}
8797
8798/*
8799 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
8800 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
8801 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
8802 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
8803 *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
8804 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
8805 * @gfp: allocation flags
8806 *
8807 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
8808 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
8809 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
8810 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
8811 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
8812 */
8813void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8814				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
8815				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
8816
8817/*
8818 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
8819 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
8820 *
8821 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
8822 */
8823u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
8824
8825/**
8826 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
8827 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
8828 *
8829 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
8830 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
8831 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
8832 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
8833 * is unbound from the driver.
8834 *
8835 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8836 */
8837void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
8838
8839/**
8840 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
8841 * @dev: the netdev to register
8842 *
8843 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8844 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
8845 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
8846 * instead as well.
8847 *
8848 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8849 */
8850int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
8851
8852/**
8853 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
8854 * @dev: the netdev to register
8855 *
8856 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8857 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
8858 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
8859 * usable instead as well.
8860 *
8861 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8862 */
8863static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
8864{
8865#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
8866	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
8867#endif
8868}
8869
8870/**
8871 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
8872 * @ies: FT IEs
8873 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
8874 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
8875 * @ric_ies: RIC IE
8876 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
8877 */
8878struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
8879	const u8 *ies;
8880	size_t ies_len;
8881	const u8 *target_ap;
8882	const u8 *ric_ies;
8883	size_t ric_ies_len;
8884};
8885
8886/**
8887 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
8888 * @netdev: network device
8889 * @ft_event: IE information
8890 */
8891void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8892		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
8893
8894/**
8895 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
8896 * @ies: the input IE buffer
8897 * @len: the input length
8898 * @attr: the attribute ID to find
8899 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
8900 *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
8901 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
8902 *
8903 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
8904 * copies its contents to the given buffer.
8905 *
8906 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
8907 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
8908 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
8909 */
8910int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
8911			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
8912			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
8913
8914/**
8915 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
8916 * @ies: the IE buffer
8917 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
8918 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
8919 *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
8920 *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
8921 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
8922 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
8923 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
8924 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
8925 *
8926 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
8927 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
8928 * split.
8929 *
8930 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
8931 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
8932 *
8933 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
8934 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
8935 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
8936 *
8937 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
8938 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
8939 * of the buffer should be used.
8940 */
8941size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
8942			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
8943			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
8944			      size_t offset);
8945
8946/**
8947 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
8948 * @ies: the IE buffer
8949 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
8950 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
8951 *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
8952 *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
8953 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
8954 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
8955 *
8956 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
8957 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
8958 * split.
8959 *
8960 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
8961 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
8962 *
8963 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
8964 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
8965 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
8966 *
8967 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
8968 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
8969 * of the buffer should be used.
8970 */
8971static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
8972					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
8973{
8974	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
8975}
8976
8977/**
8978 * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb
8979 * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to
8980 * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment
8981 * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments
8982 *
8983 * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation
8984 * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size
8985 * accordingly.
8986 */
8987void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id);
8988
8989/**
8990 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
8991 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
8992 * @wakeup: the wakeup report
8993 * @gfp: allocation flags
8994 *
8995 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
8996 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
8997 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
8998 * else caused the wakeup.
8999 */
9000void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9001				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
9002				   gfp_t gfp);
9003
9004/**
9005 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
9006 *
9007 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
9008 * @gfp: allocation flags
9009 *
9010 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
9011 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
9012 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
9013 */
9014void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
9015
9016/**
9017 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
9018 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9019 *
9020 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
9021 */
9022unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9023
9024/**
9025 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
9026 *
9027 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9028 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9029 *
9030 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
9031 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
9032 * the interface combinations.
9033 */
9034int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9035				struct iface_combination_params *params);
9036
9037/**
9038 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
9039 *
9040 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9041 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9042 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
9043 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
9044 *
9045 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
9046 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
9047 * purposes.
9048 */
9049int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9050			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
9051			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
9052					    void *data),
9053			       void *data);
9054
9055/*
9056 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
9057 *
9058 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9059 * @wdev: wireless device
9060 * @gfp: context flags
9061 *
9062 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
9063 * disconnected.
9064 *
9065 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
9066 */
9067void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9068			 gfp_t gfp);
9069
9070/**
9071 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
9072 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
9073 *
9074 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
9075 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
9076 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
9077 * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
9078 *
9079 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
9080 * the driver while the function is running.
9081 */
9082void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9083
9084/**
9085 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
9086 *
9087 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9088 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9089 *
9090 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9091 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9092 */
9093static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9094					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9095{
9096	u8 *ft_byte;
9097
9098	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9099	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
9100}
9101
9102/**
9103 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
9104 *
9105 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9106 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9107 *
9108 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9109 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9110 */
9111static inline bool
9112wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9113			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9114{
9115	u8 ft_byte;
9116
9117	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9118	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
9119}
9120
9121/**
9122 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
9123 * @f: NAN function that should be freed
9124 *
9125 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
9126 */
9127void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
9128
9129/**
9130 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
9131 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
9132 *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
9133 *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
9134 *	 result.
9135 *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
9136 * @inst_id: the local instance id
9137 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
9138 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
9139 * @info_len: the length of the &info
9140 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
9141 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
9142 */
9143struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
9144	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
9145	u8 inst_id;
9146	u8 peer_inst_id;
9147	const u8 *addr;
9148	u8 info_len;
9149	const u8 *info;
9150	u64 cookie;
9151};
9152
9153/**
9154 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
9155 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9156 * @match: match notification parameters
9157 * @gfp: allocation flags
9158 *
9159 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
9160 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
9161 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
9162 */
9163void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9164			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
9165
9166/**
9167 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
9168 *
9169 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9170 * @inst_id: the local instance id
9171 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
9172 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
9173 * @gfp: allocation flags
9174 *
9175 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
9176 */
9177void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9178				  u8 inst_id,
9179				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
9180				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
9181
9182/* ethtool helper */
9183void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
9184
9185/**
9186 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
9187 * @netdev: network device
9188 * @params: External authentication parameters
9189 * @gfp: allocation flags
9190 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
9191 */
9192int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
9193				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
9194				   gfp_t gfp);
9195
9196/**
9197 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
9198 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9199 * @req: the original measurement request
9200 * @result: the result data
9201 * @gfp: allocation flags
9202 */
9203void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9204			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9205			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
9206			  gfp_t gfp);
9207
9208/**
9209 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
9210 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9211 * @req: the original measurement request
9212 * @gfp: allocation flags
9213 *
9214 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
9215 * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
9216 */
9217void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9218			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9219			    gfp_t gfp);
9220
9221/**
9222 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
9223 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9224 * @iftype: interface type
9225 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
9226 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
9227 *
9228 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
9229 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
9230 * check_swif is '1'.
9231 */
9232bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
9233			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
9234
9235
9236/**
9237 * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
9238 * temporarily rejected with a comeback
9239 * @netdev: network device
9240 * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association
9241 * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
9242 *
9243 * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
9244 */
9245void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
9246			     const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
9247
9248/* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
9249
9250/* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9251
9252#define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
9253	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9254#define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9255	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9256#define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9257	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9258#define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9259	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9260#define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9261	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9262#define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9263	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9264#define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9265	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9266#define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9267	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9268#define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9269	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9270
9271#define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9272	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9273#define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9274	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9275
9276#define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9277	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9278
9279#define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9280	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9281
9282#if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9283#define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
9284#else
9285#define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
9286({									\
9287	if (0)								\
9288		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
9289	0;								\
9290})
9291#endif
9292
9293/*
9294 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9295 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9296 * file/line information and a backtrace.
9297 */
9298#define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9299	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9300
9301/**
9302 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9303 * @netdev: network device
9304 * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9305 * @gfp: allocation flags
9306 */
9307void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9308				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9309				    gfp_t gfp);
9310
9311/**
9312 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9313 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9314 */
9315void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9316
9317/**
9318 * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9319 * @dev: network device
9320 * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9321 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9322 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9323 */
9324int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9325			      enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9326			      u64 color_bitmap);
9327
9328/**
9329 * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9330 * @dev: network device
9331 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9332 */
9333static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9334						       u64 color_bitmap)
9335{
9336	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9337					 0, color_bitmap);
9338}
9339
9340/**
9341 * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9342 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9343 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9344 *
9345 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9346 */
9347static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9348						       u8 count)
9349{
9350	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9351					 count, 0);
9352}
9353
9354/**
9355 * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9356 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9357 *
9358 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9359 */
9360static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9361{
9362	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9363					 0, 0);
9364}
9365
9366/**
9367 * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9368 * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9369 *
9370 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9371 */
9372static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9373{
9374	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev,
9375					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9376					 0, 0);
9377}
9378
9379/**
9380 * cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap - validate puncturing bitmap
9381 * @bitmap: bitmap to be validated
9382 * @chandef: channel definition
9383 *
9384 * Validate the puncturing bitmap.
9385 *
9386 * Return: %true if the bitmap is valid. %false otherwise.
9387 */
9388bool cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap(u16 *bitmap,
9389					      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
9390
9391/**
9392 * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links.
9393 * @dev: network device.
9394 * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs.
9395 *
9396 * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to
9397 * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link
9398 * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this
9399 * case disconnect instead.
9400 * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held.
9401 */
9402void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask);
9403
9404/**
9405 * cfg80211_schedule_channels_check - schedule regulatory check if needed
9406 * @wdev: the wireless device to check
9407 *
9408 * In case the device supports NO_IR or DFS relaxations, schedule regulatory
9409 * channels check, as previous concurrent operation conditions may not
9410 * hold anymore.
9411 */
9412void cfg80211_schedule_channels_check(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9413
9414#ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS
9415/**
9416 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs
9417 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9418 * @file: the file being read
9419 * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from
9420 * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9421 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to
9422 * @count: read count
9423 * @ppos: read position
9424 * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9425 * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler
9426 */
9427ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9428				  char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9429				  char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9430				  loff_t *ppos,
9431				  ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9432						     struct file *file,
9433						     char *buf,
9434						     size_t bufsize,
9435						     void *data),
9436				  void *data);
9437
9438/**
9439 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs
9440 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9441 * @file: the file being written to
9442 * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to
9443 * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9444 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from
9445 * @count: read count
9446 * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9447 * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler
9448 */
9449ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9450				   char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9451				   const char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9452				   ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9453						      struct file *file,
9454						      char *buf,
9455						      size_t count,
9456						      void *data),
9457				   void *data);
9458#endif
9459
9460#endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */